US20190348285A1 - Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same - Google Patents
Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20190348285A1 US20190348285A1 US16/519,067 US201916519067A US2019348285A1 US 20190348285 A1 US20190348285 A1 US 20190348285A1 US 201916519067 A US201916519067 A US 201916519067A US 2019348285 A1 US2019348285 A1 US 2019348285A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- oxide semiconductor
- layer
- thin film
- semiconductor layer
- film transistor
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
- 239000004065 semiconductor Substances 0.000 title claims abstract description 461
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 title abstract description 93
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 title abstract description 38
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 claims abstract description 77
- 239000013078 crystal Substances 0.000 claims description 34
- 229910052739 hydrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 27
- 239000001257 hydrogen Substances 0.000 claims description 24
- UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrogen Chemical compound [H][H] UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 19
- 239000011701 zinc Substances 0.000 claims description 10
- 229910052738 indium Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 7
- 229910052725 zinc Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 5
- APFVFJFRJDLVQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N indium atom Chemical compound [In] APFVFJFRJDLVQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 4
- 238000001004 secondary ion mass spectrometry Methods 0.000 claims description 4
- 238000004611 spectroscopical analysis Methods 0.000 claims description 3
- HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zinc Chemical compound [Zn] HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims 3
- 239000010408 film Substances 0.000 abstract description 341
- 239000010409 thin film Substances 0.000 abstract description 272
- 238000010438 heat treatment Methods 0.000 abstract description 159
- 239000012535 impurity Substances 0.000 abstract description 44
- 238000006356 dehydrogenation reaction Methods 0.000 abstract description 29
- 230000018044 dehydration Effects 0.000 abstract description 28
- 238000006297 dehydration reaction Methods 0.000 abstract description 28
- 230000009467 reduction Effects 0.000 abstract description 7
- 239000010410 layer Substances 0.000 description 656
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 description 139
- 230000002829 reductive effect Effects 0.000 description 77
- XLOMVQKBTHCTTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zinc monoxide Chemical compound [Zn]=O XLOMVQKBTHCTTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 75
- 239000012298 atmosphere Substances 0.000 description 60
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 60
- 238000012360 testing method Methods 0.000 description 60
- 239000004973 liquid crystal related substance Substances 0.000 description 50
- 238000004544 sputter deposition Methods 0.000 description 49
- 229910052760 oxygen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 48
- IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N Atomic nitrogen Chemical compound N#N IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 46
- 239000001301 oxygen Substances 0.000 description 45
- XKRFYHLGVUSROY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Argon Chemical compound [Ar] XKRFYHLGVUSROY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 44
- QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N atomic oxygen Chemical compound [O] QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 44
- 239000007789 gas Substances 0.000 description 41
- 229910007541 Zn O Inorganic materials 0.000 description 40
- 239000012299 nitrogen atmosphere Substances 0.000 description 36
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 35
- VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicium dioxide Chemical compound O=[Si]=O VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 29
- 230000001681 protective effect Effects 0.000 description 29
- 229910052814 silicon oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 29
- 238000010583 slow cooling Methods 0.000 description 27
- 239000011261 inert gas Substances 0.000 description 26
- 239000002245 particle Substances 0.000 description 26
- 239000000956 alloy Substances 0.000 description 23
- 229910052786 argon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 23
- 238000005530 etching Methods 0.000 description 23
- 229910052757 nitrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 23
- 229910052782 aluminium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 22
- 229910045601 alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 21
- 229910052581 Si3N4 Inorganic materials 0.000 description 19
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 19
- HQVNEWCFYHHQES-UHFFFAOYSA-N silicon nitride Chemical compound N12[Si]34N5[Si]62N3[Si]51N64 HQVNEWCFYHHQES-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 19
- 239000010936 titanium Substances 0.000 description 19
- 239000003990 capacitor Substances 0.000 description 18
- 238000005259 measurement Methods 0.000 description 18
- 239000003094 microcapsule Substances 0.000 description 18
- 239000000123 paper Substances 0.000 description 17
- 229910052719 titanium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 17
- XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminium Chemical compound [Al] XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 16
- 229920005989 resin Polymers 0.000 description 16
- 239000011347 resin Substances 0.000 description 16
- 230000005684 electric field Effects 0.000 description 15
- 238000000206 photolithography Methods 0.000 description 15
- 239000001307 helium Substances 0.000 description 14
- 229910052734 helium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 14
- SWQJXJOGLNCZEY-UHFFFAOYSA-N helium atom Chemical compound [He] SWQJXJOGLNCZEY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 14
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 14
- 229910052750 molybdenum Inorganic materials 0.000 description 14
- 239000011241 protective layer Substances 0.000 description 14
- XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicon Chemical compound [Si] XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 13
- 125000004429 atom Chemical group 0.000 description 13
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 13
- 229910052710 silicon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 13
- 239000010703 silicon Substances 0.000 description 13
- RTAQQCXQSZGOHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N Titanium Chemical compound [Ti] RTAQQCXQSZGOHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 12
- 239000011521 glass Substances 0.000 description 12
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 12
- 239000002356 single layer Substances 0.000 description 12
- 229910052721 tungsten Inorganic materials 0.000 description 12
- 239000011787 zinc oxide Substances 0.000 description 12
- 239000011651 chromium Substances 0.000 description 11
- 239000004020 conductor Substances 0.000 description 11
- ZOKXTWBITQBERF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Molybdenum Chemical compound [Mo] ZOKXTWBITQBERF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- 229910003437 indium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 10
- PJXISJQVUVHSOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N indium(iii) oxide Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[In+3].[In+3] PJXISJQVUVHSOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- 239000011733 molybdenum Substances 0.000 description 10
- 229910052754 neon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 10
- GKAOGPIIYCISHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N neon atom Chemical compound [Ne] GKAOGPIIYCISHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Acetic acid Chemical compound CC(O)=O QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 9
- 229910052804 chromium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 9
- 239000000565 sealant Substances 0.000 description 9
- 229910052715 tantalum Inorganic materials 0.000 description 9
- 238000000151 deposition Methods 0.000 description 8
- 229910052733 gallium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 8
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 description 8
- 238000001039 wet etching Methods 0.000 description 8
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 description 7
- 230000008021 deposition Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000007667 floating Methods 0.000 description 7
- 239000007788 liquid Substances 0.000 description 7
- 239000010937 tungsten Substances 0.000 description 7
- NBIIXXVUZAFLBC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Phosphoric acid Chemical compound OP(O)(O)=O NBIIXXVUZAFLBC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 238000004040 coloring Methods 0.000 description 6
- AMGQUBHHOARCQH-UHFFFAOYSA-N indium;oxotin Chemical compound [In].[Sn]=O AMGQUBHHOARCQH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 description 6
- 230000037431 insertion Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000003252 repetitive effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N tungsten Chemical compound [W] WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 239000012300 argon atmosphere Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000001312 dry etching Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000008030 elimination Effects 0.000 description 5
- 238000003379 elimination reaction Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000011156 evaluation Methods 0.000 description 5
- -1 hydrogen ions Chemical class 0.000 description 5
- 229910044991 metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 5
- 150000004706 metal oxides Chemical class 0.000 description 5
- QGLKJKCYBOYXKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N nonaoxidotritungsten Chemical compound O=[W]1(=O)O[W](=O)(=O)O[W](=O)(=O)O1 QGLKJKCYBOYXKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 239000000049 pigment Substances 0.000 description 5
- 229920003023 plastic Polymers 0.000 description 5
- 239000004033 plastic Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000004088 simulation Methods 0.000 description 5
- 239000012798 spherical particle Substances 0.000 description 5
- 229910001930 tungsten oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 5
- VYZAMTAEIAYCRO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chromium Chemical compound [Cr] VYZAMTAEIAYCRO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 229910052779 Neodymium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- GWEVSGVZZGPLCZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Titan oxide Chemical compound O=[Ti]=O GWEVSGVZZGPLCZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 4
- 150000001875 compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 238000001816 cooling Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229910052802 copper Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 239000010949 copper Substances 0.000 description 4
- KPUWHANPEXNPJT-UHFFFAOYSA-N disiloxane Chemical class [SiH3]O[SiH3] KPUWHANPEXNPJT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 239000000428 dust Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000000945 filler Substances 0.000 description 4
- 150000002431 hydrogen Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 230000006872 improvement Effects 0.000 description 4
- 229910052742 iron Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 239000011859 microparticle Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000000329 molecular dynamics simulation Methods 0.000 description 4
- QEFYFXOXNSNQGX-UHFFFAOYSA-N neodymium atom Chemical compound [Nd] QEFYFXOXNSNQGX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 229910052759 nickel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 150000002894 organic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 125000004430 oxygen atom Chemical group O* 0.000 description 4
- 238000005192 partition Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000005268 plasma chemical vapour deposition Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000007670 refining Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229910052706 scandium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- SIXSYDAISGFNSX-UHFFFAOYSA-N scandium atom Chemical compound [Sc] SIXSYDAISGFNSX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 239000000243 solution Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000002904 solvent Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000003068 static effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000003860 storage Methods 0.000 description 4
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 description 4
- GUVRBAGPIYLISA-UHFFFAOYSA-N tantalum atom Chemical compound [Ta] GUVRBAGPIYLISA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- VZGDMQKNWNREIO-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrachloromethane Chemical compound ClC(Cl)(Cl)Cl VZGDMQKNWNREIO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- OGIDPMRJRNCKJF-UHFFFAOYSA-N titanium oxide Inorganic materials [Ti]=O OGIDPMRJRNCKJF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 210000000707 wrist Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- YVTHLONGBIQYBO-UHFFFAOYSA-N zinc indium(3+) oxygen(2-) Chemical compound [O--].[Zn++].[In+3] YVTHLONGBIQYBO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chlorine atom Chemical compound [Cl] ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- XPDWGBQVDMORPB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Fluoroform Chemical compound FC(F)F XPDWGBQVDMORPB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 230000005355 Hall effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- GRYLNZFGIOXLOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Nitric acid Chemical compound O[N+]([O-])=O GRYLNZFGIOXLOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- NRTOMJZYCJJWKI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Titanium nitride Chemical compound [Ti]#N NRTOMJZYCJJWKI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- NIXOWILDQLNWCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N acrylic acid group Chemical group C(C=C)(=O)O NIXOWILDQLNWCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 229910000147 aluminium phosphate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000000460 chlorine Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910052801 chlorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000003086 colorant Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000002425 crystallisation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000008025 crystallization Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000003795 desorption Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000010586 diagram Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000009792 diffusion process Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000009826 distribution Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000005262 ferroelectric liquid crystals (FLCs) Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000007769 metal material Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910017604 nitric acid Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 230000003287 optical effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229920006267 polyester film Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 229920002620 polyvinyl fluoride Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000002441 reversible effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000000630 rising effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000007787 solid Substances 0.000 description 3
- TXEYQDLBPFQVAA-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrafluoromethane Chemical compound FC(F)(F)F TXEYQDLBPFQVAA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000002699 waste material Substances 0.000 description 3
- UWCWUCKPEYNDNV-LBPRGKRZSA-N 2,6-dimethyl-n-[[(2s)-pyrrolidin-2-yl]methyl]aniline Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC(C)=C1NC[C@H]1NCCC1 UWCWUCKPEYNDNV-LBPRGKRZSA-N 0.000 description 2
- QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ammonia Chemical compound N QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000004215 Carbon black (E152) Substances 0.000 description 2
- CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbon dioxide Chemical compound O=C=O CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- KZBUYRJDOAKODT-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chlorine Chemical compound ClCl KZBUYRJDOAKODT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Copper Chemical compound [Cu] RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- YCKRFDGAMUMZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-N Fluorine atom Chemical compound [F] YCKRFDGAMUMZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- GYHNNYVSQQEPJS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Gallium Chemical compound [Ga] GYHNNYVSQQEPJS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010052128 Glare Diseases 0.000 description 2
- VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrochloric acid Chemical compound Cl VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- MHAJPDPJQMAIIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrogen peroxide Chemical compound OO MHAJPDPJQMAIIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N Magnesium Chemical compound [Mg] FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000004642 Polyimide Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910020923 Sn-O Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- QCWXUUIWCKQGHC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zirconium Chemical compound [Zr] QCWXUUIWCKQGHC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- AZWHFTKIBIQKCA-UHFFFAOYSA-N [Sn+2]=O.[O-2].[In+3] Chemical compound [Sn+2]=O.[O-2].[In+3] AZWHFTKIBIQKCA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052790 beryllium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- ATBAMAFKBVZNFJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N beryllium atom Chemical compound [Be] ATBAMAFKBVZNFJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000005380 borophosphosilicate glass Substances 0.000 description 2
- DQXBYHZEEUGOBF-UHFFFAOYSA-N but-3-enoic acid;ethene Chemical compound C=C.OC(=O)CC=C DQXBYHZEEUGOBF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000004364 calculation method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001413 cellular effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000004140 cleaning Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000000052 comparative effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000002131 composite material Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920001940 conductive polymer Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000000356 contaminant Substances 0.000 description 2
- 150000001879 copper Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- PMHQVHHXPFUNSP-UHFFFAOYSA-M copper(1+);methylsulfanylmethane;bromide Chemical compound Br[Cu].CSC PMHQVHHXPFUNSP-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 2
- 230000003247 decreasing effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000009977 dual effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000005611 electricity Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005401 electroluminescence Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000005038 ethylene vinyl acetate Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000001747 exhibiting effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000004744 fabric Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000011152 fibreglass Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052731 fluorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000011737 fluorine Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000001153 fluoro group Chemical group F* 0.000 description 2
- QZQVBEXLDFYHSR-UHFFFAOYSA-N gallium(III) oxide Inorganic materials O=[Ga]O[Ga]=O QZQVBEXLDFYHSR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229930195733 hydrocarbon Natural products 0.000 description 2
- 150000002430 hydrocarbons Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- GPRLSGONYQIRFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N hydron Chemical compound [H+] GPRLSGONYQIRFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000009616 inductively coupled plasma Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229910010272 inorganic material Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000011810 insulating material Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052749 magnesium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000011777 magnesium Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000696 magnetic material Substances 0.000 description 2
- WPBNNNQJVZRUHP-UHFFFAOYSA-L manganese(2+);methyl n-[[2-(methoxycarbonylcarbamothioylamino)phenyl]carbamothioyl]carbamate;n-[2-(sulfidocarbothioylamino)ethyl]carbamodithioate Chemical compound [Mn+2].[S-]C(=S)NCCNC([S-])=S.COC(=O)NC(=S)NC1=CC=CC=C1NC(=S)NC(=O)OC WPBNNNQJVZRUHP-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- 239000011259 mixed solution Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000002159 nanocrystal Substances 0.000 description 2
- 150000004767 nitrides Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 125000000962 organic group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 239000011368 organic material Substances 0.000 description 2
- TWNQGVIAIRXVLR-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxo(oxoalumanyloxy)alumane Chemical compound O=[Al]O[Al]=O TWNQGVIAIRXVLR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000000059 patterning Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000005360 phosphosilicate glass Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000001020 plasma etching Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229920001200 poly(ethylene-vinyl acetate) Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920002037 poly(vinyl butyral) polymer Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920001721 polyimide Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920000915 polyvinyl chloride Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000004800 polyvinyl chloride Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000001552 radio frequency sputter deposition Methods 0.000 description 2
- 125000006850 spacer group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 238000003786 synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- XOLBLPGZBRYERU-UHFFFAOYSA-N tin dioxide Chemical compound O=[Sn]=O XOLBLPGZBRYERU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000001771 vacuum deposition Methods 0.000 description 2
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Substances O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052726 zirconium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000004925 Acrylic resin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000178 Acrylic resin Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910000838 Al alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910017073 AlLi Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000004986 Cholesteric liquid crystals (ChLC) Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004593 Epoxy Substances 0.000 description 1
- CPELXLSAUQHCOX-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrogen bromide Chemical compound Br CPELXLSAUQHCOX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010021143 Hypoxia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000004952 Polyamide Substances 0.000 description 1
- BLRPTPMANUNPDV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silane Chemical compound [SiH4] BLRPTPMANUNPDV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910002808 Si–O–Si Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 206010047571 Visual impairment Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000010521 absorption reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000001133 acceleration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000000217 alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 239000005407 aluminoborosilicate glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910021529 ammonia Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000000137 annealing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000003118 aryl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- SWXQKHHHCFXQJF-UHFFFAOYSA-N azane;hydrogen peroxide Chemical compound [NH4+].[O-]O SWXQKHHHCFXQJF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052788 barium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- DSAJWYNOEDNPEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N barium atom Chemical compound [Ba] DSAJWYNOEDNPEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UMIVXZPTRXBADB-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzocyclobutene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2CCC2=C1 UMIVXZPTRXBADB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000011230 binding agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000903 blocking effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000005388 borosilicate glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052791 calcium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000001569 carbon dioxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910002092 carbon dioxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000000919 ceramic Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003098 cholesteric effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011109 contamination Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229920001577 copolymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000000354 decomposition reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007872 degassing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000994 depressogenic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000013461 design Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000011161 development Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007598 dipping method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000006073 displacement reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007772 electrode material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003822 epoxy resin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000005281 excited state Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011888 foil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000013467 fragmentation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000006062 fragmentation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004313 glare Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005283 ground state Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005525 hole transport Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011065 in-situ storage Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000002347 injection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007924 injection Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000002484 inorganic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000011147 inorganic material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000002500 ions Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000005001 laminate film Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000007774 longterm Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005389 magnetism Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001755 magnetron sputter deposition Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052748 manganese Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011572 manganese Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910021645 metal ion Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000002156 mixing Methods 0.000 description 1
- GVGCUCJTUSOZKP-UHFFFAOYSA-N nitrogen trifluoride Chemical compound FN(F)F GVGCUCJTUSOZKP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000007645 offset printing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012788 optical film Substances 0.000 description 1
- AHLBNYSZXLDEJQ-FWEHEUNISA-N orlistat Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCC[C@H](OC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC=O)C[C@@H]1OC(=O)[C@H]1CCCCCC AHLBNYSZXLDEJQ-FWEHEUNISA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000010355 oscillation Effects 0.000 description 1
- BPUBBGLMJRNUCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxygen(2-);tantalum(5+) Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[Ta+5].[Ta+5] BPUBBGLMJRNUCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000003071 parasitic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000036961 partial effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000009832 plasma treatment Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229920002647 polyamide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000767 polyaniline Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000647 polyepoxide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000128 polypyrrole Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001296 polysiloxane Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000123 polythiophene Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000005381 potential energy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005086 pumping Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000005855 radiation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005546 reactive sputtering Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006798 recombination Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005215 recombination Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007650 screen-printing Methods 0.000 description 1
- FDNAPBUWERUEDA-UHFFFAOYSA-N silicon tetrachloride Chemical compound Cl[Si](Cl)(Cl)Cl FDNAPBUWERUEDA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920002050 silicone resin Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910001415 sodium ion Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000004528 spin coating Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005507 spraying Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000010935 stainless steel Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910001220 stainless steel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000007858 starting material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000001424 substituent group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- SFZCNBIFKDRMGX-UHFFFAOYSA-N sulfur hexafluoride Chemical compound FS(F)(F)(F)(F)F SFZCNBIFKDRMGX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000001360 synchronised effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- MZLGASXMSKOWSE-UHFFFAOYSA-N tantalum nitride Chemical compound [Ta]#N MZLGASXMSKOWSE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910001936 tantalum oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000013076 target substance Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000002230 thermal chemical vapour deposition Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229920001187 thermosetting polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910001887 tin oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000007704 transition Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000013519 translation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000002834 transmittance Methods 0.000 description 1
- FAQYAMRNWDIXMY-UHFFFAOYSA-N trichloroborane Chemical compound ClB(Cl)Cl FAQYAMRNWDIXMY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000007740 vapor deposition Methods 0.000 description 1
- OYQCBJZGELKKPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N zinc indium(3+) oxygen(2-) Chemical compound [O-2].[Zn+2].[O-2].[In+3] OYQCBJZGELKKPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L21/00—Processes or apparatus adapted for the manufacture or treatment of semiconductor or solid state devices or of parts thereof
- H01L21/02—Manufacture or treatment of semiconductor devices or of parts thereof
- H01L21/02104—Forming layers
- H01L21/02365—Forming inorganic semiconducting materials on a substrate
- H01L21/02656—Special treatments
- H01L21/02664—Aftertreatments
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L21/00—Processes or apparatus adapted for the manufacture or treatment of semiconductor or solid state devices or of parts thereof
- H01L21/02—Manufacture or treatment of semiconductor devices or of parts thereof
- H01L21/02104—Forming layers
- H01L21/02365—Forming inorganic semiconducting materials on a substrate
- H01L21/02518—Deposited layers
- H01L21/02521—Materials
- H01L21/02565—Oxide semiconducting materials not being Group 12/16 materials, e.g. ternary compounds
-
- H01L27/1225—
-
- H01L29/66742—
-
- H01L29/66765—
-
- H01L29/66969—
-
- H01L29/78603—
-
- H01L29/78606—
-
- H01L29/78618—
-
- H01L29/78624—
-
- H01L29/7869—
-
- H01L29/78693—
-
- H01L29/78696—
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/11—Device type
- H01L2924/13—Discrete devices, e.g. 3 terminal devices
- H01L2924/1304—Transistor
- H01L2924/1306—Field-effect transistor [FET]
- H01L2924/13069—Thin film transistor [TFT]
Definitions
- the present invention relates to a semiconductor device including an oxide semiconductor and a manufacturing method thereof.
- a semiconductor device generally means a device which can function by utilizing semiconductor characteristics
- an electrooptic device, a semiconductor circuit, and an electronic appliance are all semiconductor devices.
- TFT thin film transistor
- a semiconductor thin film having a thickness of approximately several nanometers to several hundred nanometers
- Various metal oxides are used for a variety of applications. Indium oxide is a well-known material and is used as a transparent electrode material which is necessary for liquid crystal displays and the like.
- Some metal oxides have semiconductor characteristics. Examples of such metal oxides having semiconductor characteristics include tungsten oxide, tin oxide, indium oxide, and zinc oxide. Thin film transistors including such metal oxide having semiconductor characteristics in its channel formation region have been proposed (Patent Documents 1 to 4 and Non-Patent Document 1).
- metal oxides include not only an oxide of a single metal element but also an oxide of a plurality of metal elements (multi-component oxides).
- multi-component oxides For example, InGaO 3 (ZnO) m (m is a natural number) which is a homologous compound is a known material as multi-component oxides including In, Ga, and Zn (Non-Patent Documents 2 to 4).
- Patent Document 5 an oxide semiconductor including such an In—Ga—Zn based oxide can be used as a channel layer of a thin film transistor (Patent Document 5, and Non-Patent Documents 5 and 6).
- heat treatment (which is for dehydration or dehydrogenation) is performed so as to improve the purity of the oxide semiconductor film and reduce impurities such as moisture.
- heat treatment causes reduction of impurities such as moisture existing in the gate insulating layer and those in interfaces between the oxide semiconductor film and films which are provided over and below the oxide semiconductor film and are in contact with the oxide semiconductor film.
- heat treatment is performed under an inert-gas atmosphere of nitrogen or a rare gas such as argon or helium or under reduced pressure, at 200° C. or higher, preferably, 400° C. to 600° C. inclusive.
- the formed oxide semiconductor film is exposed.
- impurities such as moisture, which are contained in the oxide semiconductor film, are reduced.
- slow cooling is performed to a temperature which is equal to or higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C. under an inert-gas atmosphere.
- Heat treatment was performed on a plurality of samples under a nitrogen atmosphere at heat temperatures whose conditions were determined. Such a plurality of samples were measured with thermal desorption spectroscopy (TDS). Measurement results are shown in FIG. 2 , FIG. 3 , and FIG. 4 .
- TDS thermal desorption spectroscopy
- the thermal desorption spectroscopy apparatus is used for detecting and identifying a gas component discharged or generated from the samples by a quadrupole mass analyzer; thus, a gas and a molecule discharged from surfaces and insides of the samples can be observed. Discharge or generation of gas from the samples occurs while the samples are heated and the temperature is rising in high vacuum.
- a thermal desorption spectrometer product name: EMD-WA1000S manufactured by ESCO Ltd.
- measurement was performed under a condition where the rising temperature was at approximately 10° C./min., the SEM voltage was set to 1500 V, the dwell time was 0.2 (sec), and the number of channels to be used was 23.
- the pressure was at a degree of vacuum of about 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 7 (Pa).
- the ionization coefficient, the fragmentation coefficient, the pass-through coefficient, and the pumping rate of H 2 O were respectively 1.0, 0.805, 1.56, and 1.0.
- FIG. 2 is a graph showing TDS results of comparison between a sample (comparative sample) which includes only a glass substrate and a sample (Sample 1) where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm (an actual thickness obtained after etching is about 30 nm) is formed over a glass substrate.
- FIG. 2 shows results obtained by measuring H 2 O. Discharge of impurities such as moisture (H 2 O) from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film can be confirmed from a peak in the vicinity of 300° C.
- FIG. 3 is a graph showing comparison of samples, which shows TDS measurement results of H 2 O.
- the comparison was performed on the following samples: the sample (Sample 1) where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm is formed over a glass substrate; a sample (Sample 2) where the structure of Sample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 350° C. under an air atmosphere; and a sample (Sample 3) where the structure of Sample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 350° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. From the results shown in FIG. 3 , a peak in the vicinity of 300° C. of Sample 3 is lower than that of Sample 2. Thus, discharge of moisture (H 2 O) due to heat treatment performed under a nitrogen atmosphere can be confirmed. Moreover, it is found that heat treatment performed under a nitrogen atmosphere reduces impurities such as moisture (H 2 O) more than heat treatment performed under an air atmosphere.
- FIG. 4 is a graph showing comparison of samples, which shows TDS measurement results of H 2 O. The comparison was performed on the following samples: the sample (Sample 1) where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm is formed over a glass substrate; a sample (Sample 4) where the structure of Sample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 250° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere; the sample (Sample 3) where the structure of Sample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 350° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere; a sample (Sample 5) where the structure of Sample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 450° C.
- peaks can be confirmed: a first peak in the vicinity of 200° C. to 250° C., which indicates discharge of impurities such as moisture (H 2 O); and a second peak at 300° C. or higher, which indicates discharge of impurities such as moisture (H 2 O).
- FIG. 1 shows measurement results of carrier concentrations. Conditions of heat temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere were set to 150° C., 175° C., 200° C., 225° C., 250° C., 275° C., 300° C., 325° C., 350° C., 375° C., 400° C., 425° C., and 450° C., and a carrier concentration at each temperature was measured.
- FIG. 5A illustrates a three-dimensional view of a property-evaluation sample 510 for evaluating properties (the carrier concentrations and Hall mobility) of an oxide semiconductor film (an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film).
- the property-evaluation sample 510 was fabricated and subjected to Hall effect measurement at room temperature. The carrier concentration and Hall mobility of the oxide semiconductor film were evaluated.
- the property-evaluation sample 510 was fabricated in the following manner: an insulating film 501 including silicon oxynitride was formed over a substrate 500 , an oxide semiconductor film 502 with a size of 10 mm ⁇ 10 mm, which serves as an evaluation object, was formed over the insulating film 501 , and electrodes 503 to 506 each having a diameter of 1 mm were formed over the oxide semiconductor film 502 .
- the carrier concentrations of the oxide semiconductor film obtained by the Hall effect measurement are shown in FIG. 1
- the Hall mobility thereof is shown in FIG. 5B
- conductivity thereof is shown in FIG. 5C .
- H, O, OH, H 2 , O 2 , N, N 2 , and Ar, in addition to H 2 O were each measured by TDS.
- the measurement resulted in that peaks of H 2 O, H, O, and OH were observed clearly but peaks of H 2 , O 2 , N, N 2 , and Ar were not observed.
- a structure where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm was formed over a glass substrate was used as samples of the above measurement.
- the conditions of heat treatment were set as follows: heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for an hour; that under a nitrogen atmosphere at 350° C.
- FIG. 37 , FIG. 38 , FIG. 39 , and FIG. 40 show TDS results of H, O, OH, and H 2 , respectively. Note that under the above conditions of heat treatment, the oxygen concentration under a nitrogen atmosphere is 20 ppm or lower.
- heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation heat treatment performed under an inert-gas atmosphere of nitrogen or an inert gas such as argon or helium or under reduced pressure.
- dehydrogenation does not indicate elimination of only H 2 by heat treatment.
- elimination of H, OH, and the like is referred to as “dehydration or dehydrogenation”.
- Impurities (H 2 O) contained in an oxide semiconductor layer is reduced and the carrier concentration are increased by heat treatment performed under an inert gas, and then slow cooling is performed. After slow cooling, the carrier concentration in the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced by formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer or the like, which leads to improvement in reliability.
- the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher
- the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 , more preferably 1 ⁇ 10 14 /cm 3 or lower.
- an inorganic insulating film which blocks impurities such as moisture, hydrogen ions, and OH ⁇ is used as the oxide insulating film formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer.
- an inorganic insulating film which blocks impurities such as moisture, hydrogen ions, and OH ⁇ is used as the oxide insulating film formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer.
- a silicon oxide film or a silicon nitride oxide film is used as a silicon nitride oxide film.
- second heat treatment may be performed after formation of the oxide insulating film serving as a protective film to be over and in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer.
- variation in electric characteristics of thin film transistors can be reduced.
- One embodiment of the present invention disclosed in this specification is a semiconductor device including a gate electrode layer, a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, and an insulating layer over the oxide semiconductor layer.
- the gate insulating layer, the oxide semiconductor layer, the insulating layer, an interface between the gate insulating layer and the oxide semiconductor layer, and an interface between the oxide semiconductor layer and the insulating layer have a hydrogen concentration of 3 ⁇ 10 20 cm ⁇ 3 or lower.
- Moisture contained in the oxide semiconductor layer includes a variety of forms such as moisture (H 2 O), M-OH, M-H, and the like as well as hydrogen.
- An average value or a peak value of the hydrogen concentration which is the absolute quantity is 3 ⁇ 10 20 cm ⁇ 3 or lower, preferably 1 ⁇ 10 20 cm ⁇ 3 or lower.
- SIMS secondary ion mass spectrometry
- One embodiment of the present invention to realize the above structure is a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device including the steps of forming a gate electrode layer, forming a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, forming an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, performing dehydration or dehydrogenation on the oxide semiconductor layer, forming a source electrode layer and a drain electrode layer over the dehydrated or dehydrogenated oxide semiconductor layer, and forming an oxide insulating film which is in contact with a part of the oxide semiconductor layer and over the gate insulating layer, the oxide semiconductor layer, the source electrode layer, and the drain electrode layer.
- dehydration or dehydrogenation is heat treatment performed under a nitrogen atmosphere or a rare gas atmosphere or under reduced pressure.
- Another embodiment of the present invention to realize the above structure is a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device including the steps of forming a gate electrode layer, forming a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, forming an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, heating the oxide semiconductor layer under an inert atmosphere to increase a carrier concentration, forming a source electrode layer and a drain electrode layer over the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is increased, and forming an oxide insulating film which is in contact with a part of the heated oxide semiconductor layer and over the gate insulating layer, the heated oxide semiconductor layer, the source electrode layer, and the drain electrode layer, so that a carrier concentration is reduced.
- the oxide semiconductor layer is heated under an inert atmosphere at a temperature of 400° C. or higher, slow cooling is performed to a temperature which is equal to higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C.
- Another embodiment of the present invention to realize the above structure is a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device including the steps of forming a gate electrode layer, forming a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, forming an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, heating the oxide semiconductor layer under a reduced pressure to increase a carrier concentration, forming a source electrode layer and a drain electrode layer over the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is increased, and forming an oxide insulating film which is in contact with a part of the heated oxide semiconductor layer and over the gate insulating layer, the heated oxide semiconductor layer, and the source electrode layer, and the drain electrode layer, so that a carrier concentration is reduced.
- the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is increased is 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher.
- the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is reduced due to formation of the oxide insulating film is lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 , preferably 1 ⁇ 10 14 /cm 3 or lower.
- the oxide semiconductor used in this specification is, for example, a thin film expressed by InMO 3 (ZnO) m (m>0), and a thin film transistor using the thin film as a semiconductor layer is manufactured.
- M denotes one metal element or a plurality of metal elements selected from Ga, Fe, Ni, Mn, and Co.
- M denotes Ga in some cases; meanwhile, M denotes the above metal element such as Ni or Fe in addition to Ga (Ga and Ni or Ga and Fe) in other cases.
- the above oxide semiconductor may include Fe or Ni, another transitional metal element, or an oxide of the transitional metal as an impurity element in addition to the metal element included as M.
- an oxide semiconductor whose composition formula is represented as InMO 3 (ZnO) m (m>0) where at least Ga is included as M is referred to as an In-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor, and a thin film thereof is also referred to as an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film.
- any of the following oxide semiconductors can be applied in addition to the above: an In-Sn-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-Al-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an Al-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-Al-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-Ga-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an Al-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-O-based oxide semiconductor; and a Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor.
- silicon oxide may be included in the above oxide semiconductor layer.
- Addition of silicon oxide (SiO x (x>0)) which hinders crystallization into the oxide semiconductor layer can suppress crystallization of the oxide semiconductor layer in the case where heat treatment is performed after formation of the oxide semiconductor layer in the manufacturing process. Note that the preferable state of the oxide semiconductor layer is amorphous, or partial crystallization thereof is acceptable.
- the oxide semiconductor preferably includes In, further preferably, includes In and Ga. Dehydration or dehydrogenation is effective in a process of forming an i-type (intrinsic) oxide semiconductor layer.
- a protective circuit for protecting the driver circuit is preferably provided over the same substrate as a gate line or a source line.
- the protective circuit is preferably formed with a non-linear element including an oxide semiconductor.
- treatment of the gate insulating layer and the oxide semiconductor film may be successively performed without exposure to air. Such treatment is also called successive treatment, an in-situ step, or successive film formation. Successive treatment without exposure to air enables an interface between the gate insulating layer and the oxide semiconductor film to be formed without being contaminated by atmospheric components or contamination impurities floating in the air, such as moisture or hydrocarbon. Thus, variation in characteristics of thin film transistors can be reduced.
- successive treatment in this specification means that during the process from a first treatment step performed by a PCVD method or a sputtering method to a second treatment step performed by a PCVD method or a sputtering method, an atmosphere in which a substrate to be processed is disposed is not contaminated by a contaminant atmosphere such as air, and is constantly controlled to be vacuum or an inert-gas atmosphere (a nitrogen atmosphere or a rare gas atmosphere).
- a contaminant atmosphere such as air
- an inert-gas atmosphere a nitrogen atmosphere or a rare gas atmosphere
- Performing the process from the first treatment step to the second treatment step in the same chamber is within the scope of the successive treatment in this specification. Further, the case where the process from the first treatment step to the second treatment is performed in different chambers in the following manner is also within the scope of the successive treatment in this specification: the substrate is transferred after the first treatment step to another chamber without being exposed to air and subjected to the second treatment.
- a substrate transfer step an alignment step, a slow cooling step, a heating or cooling a substrate step which is for setting the substrate to have temperature suitable to the second film formation step, or the like.
- a thin film transistor having stable electric characteristics can be provided. Further, a semiconductor device which includes thin film transistors having excellent electric characteristics and high reliability can be provided.
- FIG. 1 is a graph showing the carrier concentration of an oxide semiconductor layer with respect to heating temperatures.
- FIG. 2 is a graph showing TDS measurement results.
- FIG. 3 is a graph showing TDS measurement results.
- FIG. 4 is a graph showing TDS measurement results.
- FIG. 5A is a three-dimensional view of a property-evaluation sample
- FIG. 5B is a graph showing results of Hall effect measurement of an oxide semiconductor layer
- FIG. 5C is a graph showing conductivity.
- FIGS. 6A to 6D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 7A and 7B illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 8A to 8D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 9A and 9B illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 10A to 10D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 11A to 11C are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 12 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 13 A 1 and 13 A 2 and FIGS. 13 B 1 and 13 B 2 illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 14 is a cross-sectional view of an electric furnace.
- FIG. 15 illustrates a semiconductor device
- FIGS. 16 A 1 and 16 A 2 and 16 B illustrate a semiconductor device.
- FIGS. 17A and 17B illustrate a semiconductor device.
- FIG. 18 illustrates a pixel equivalent circuit of a semiconductor device.
- FIGS. 19A to 19C illustrate a semiconductor device.
- FIGS. 20A and 20B are each a block diagram of a semiconductor device.
- FIG. 21 illustrates a configuration of a signal line driver circuit.
- FIG. 22 is a timing chart of operation of a signal line driver circuit.
- FIG. 23 is a timing chart illustrating operation of a signal line driver circuit.
- FIG. 24 illustrates a configuration of a shift register.
- FIG. 25 illustrates a connection structure of a flip-flop of FIG. 24 .
- FIG. 26 illustrates a semiconductor device
- FIG. 27 is an external view illustrating an example of an e-book reader.
- FIGS. 28A and 28B are external views respectively illustrating an example of a television set and an example of a digital photo frame.
- FIGS. 29A and 29B are external views illustrating examples of game machines.
- FIGS. 30A and 30B are external views illustrating an example of a portable computer and an example of a mobile phone, respectively.
- FIGS. 31A to 31D illustrate a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device.
- FIG. 32 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 33 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 34A to 34C illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIGS. 35A and 35B illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 36 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 37 is a graph showing TDS results about H.
- FIG. 38 is a graph showing TDS results about O.
- FIG. 39 is a graph showing TDS results about OH.
- FIG. 40 is a graph showing TDS results about H 2 .
- FIGS. 41A to 41C are graphs each showing Vg-Id characteristics of a thin film transistor before and after a BT test.
- FIG. 42 is a view illustrating a structure of an oxide semiconductor layer used for calculation.
- FIG. 43 is a graph describing calculation results of the oxygen density in an oxide semiconductor layer.
- FIGS. 6A to 6D and FIGS. 7A and 7B A semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to FIGS. 6A to 6D and FIGS. 7A and 7B .
- FIG. 7A is a top view of a thin film transistor 470 of a semiconductor device
- FIG. 7B is a cross-sectional view along line C 1 -C 2 of FIG. 7A
- the thin film transistor 470 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over a substrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, a gate electrode layer 401 , a gate insulating layer 402 , a semiconductor layer 403 , and source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b.
- an oxide insulating film 407 is provided to cover the thin film transistor 470 and be in contact with the semiconductor layer 403 .
- the semiconductor layer 403 formed using an oxide semiconductor film is subjected to heat treatment (heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation) for reducing impurities such as moisture and the like at least after formation of the oxide semiconductor film, so that resistance is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher).
- the oxide insulating film 407 is formed to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor film, so that the oxide semiconductor film has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 , more preferably 1 ⁇ 10 14 /cm 3 or lower). Accordingly, the oxide semiconductor film can be used as a channel formation region.
- the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced by formation of an oxide insulating film to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer or the like, which improves reliability of the thin film transistor 470 .
- the heat treatment causes reduction in impurities such as moisture inside the gate insulating layer 402 and in interfaces provided between the semiconductor layer 403 formed using an oxide semiconductor and films which are over and below the semiconductor layer 403 to be in contact therewith.
- the interfaces indicate an interface between the gate insulating layer 402 and the semiconductor layer 403 and an interface between the oxide insulating film 407 and the semiconductor layer 403 .
- a bias-temperature stress test (hereinafter, referred to as a BT test).
- the BT test is one kind of an accelerated test and can evaluate change in characteristics, caused by long-term usage, of thin film transistors in a short time.
- the amount of shift in threshold voltage of the thin film transistor between before and after the BT test is an important indicator for examining reliability. Between before and after the BT test, the small amount of shift in threshold voltage means high reliability.
- the temperature of a substrate over which a thin film transistor is formed (substrate temperature) is set at fixed temperature, a source and a drain of the thin film transistor are set at the same potential, and a gate is supplied with potential different from those of the source and the drain for a certain period.
- the substrate temperature may be set as appropriate in accordance with the purpose of the test.
- a test in the case where potential applied to the gate is higher than potentials of the source and the drain is referred to as a +BT test
- a test in the case where potential applied to the gate is lower than potentials of the source and the drain is referred to as a ⁇ BT test.
- the stress conditions for the BT test can be determined by setting the substrate temperature, electric field intensity applied to a gate insulating film, or a time period of application of electric field.
- the electric field intensity applied to a gate insulating film can be determined by dividing the potential difference between the gate potential and the source and drain potential by the thickness of the gate insulating film. For example, in the case where the electric field intensity applied to the 100-nm-thick gate insulating film is to be set to 2 MV/cm, the potential difference may be set to 20 V.
- results of a BT test performed on three kinds of samples are described.
- the samples are subjected to heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C., 350° C., and 450° C., which is performed before formation of source and drain in manufacture of a thin film transistor.
- “voltage” generally indicates a difference between potentials of two points, and “potential” indicates a static electric energy (electrical potential energy) unit charge which is at a point in a static electric field has.
- a difference between a potential at a certain point and a reference potential e.g., a ground potential
- a reference potential e.g., a ground potential
- the potential at a certain point means the voltage except for the case where definition is particularly given.
- a +BT test and a ⁇ BT test were performed under such conditions that a substrate temperature was 150° C., an electric field intensity applied to a gate insulating film was 2 MV/cm, and a time period for application was one hour.
- the +BT test is described.
- a change in characteristics of the source-drain current (hereinafter, referred to as the drain current) was measured, under the conditions where the substrate temperature was set to 40° C., the voltage between source and drain (hereinafter, the drain voltage) was set to 10 V, and the voltage between source and gate (hereinafter, the gate voltage) was changed in the range of ⁇ 20 V to +20 V. That is, Vg-Id characteristics were measured.
- the substrate temperature was set to 40° C.
- the measurement may be performed at room temperature (25° C.) or lower if there is no particular problem.
- the substrate temperature was increased to 150° C., and then, the potentials of the source and the drain of the thin film transistor were set to 0 V. After that, the voltage was applied to the gate so that the electric field intensity applied to the gate insulating film was 2 MV/cm. In this case, the thickness of the gate insulating film of the thin film transistor was 100 nm.
- the gate was supplied with +20 V of voltage, and the gate supplied with the voltage was kept for one hour. Note that although the time period for voltage application was one hour here, the time period may be changed as appropriate in accordance with the purpose.
- the substrate temperature was lowered to 40° C. while the voltage was kept on being applied to the source, the drain, and the gate. If application of the voltage is stopped before the substrate temperature was completely lowered to 40° C., the thin film transistor which has been damaged during the BT test is repaired by the influence of residual heat. Thus, lowering of the substrate temperature needs to be performed with application of the voltage. After the substrate temperature was lowered to 40° C., application of the voltage was terminated.
- Vg-Id characteristics were measured under the conditions same as those for the measurement of the initial characteristics, so that the Vg-Id characteristics after the +BT test were obtained.
- the ⁇ BT test was performed with the procedure similar to the +BT test, but has a different point from the +BT test, in that the voltage applied to the gate after the substrate temperature is increased to 150° C. is set to ⁇ 20 V.
- the BT test it is important to use a thin film transistor which has been never subjected to a BT test. For example, if a ⁇ BT test is performed with use of a thin film transistor which has been once subjected to a +BT test, the results of the ⁇ BT test cannot be evaluated correctly due to influence of the +BT test which has been performed previously. Similarly, if the thin film transistor which has been once subjected to a +BT test is used for another +BT test, the results cannot be evaluated correctly.
- the usage of the thin film transistor is not limited to the above in the case where the BT test is performed repeatedly in consideration of such influence.
- FIGS. 41A to 41C show the Vg-Id characteristics before and after the BT tests.
- FIG. 41A shows the BT test results of thin film transistors each formed in such a manner that heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. before formation of a source and a drain.
- FIG. 41B shows the BT test results of thin film transistors each formed in such a manner that heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 350° C. before formation of a source and a drain.
- FIG. 41C shows the BT test results of thin film transistors each formed in such a manner that heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 450° C. before formation of a source and a drain.
- the horizontal axis represents the gate voltage (Vg) which is shown with a logarithmic scale
- the vertical axis represents the drain current (Id) which is shown with a logarithmic scale.
- Initial characteristics 711 , 721 , and 731 indicate the Vg-Id characteristics of the thin film transistors before the +BT tests
- +BTs 712 , 722 , and 732 indicate the Vg-Id characteristics of the thin film transistors after +BT tests
- ⁇ BTs 713 , 723 , and 733 indicate the Vg-Id characteristics of the thin film transistors after ⁇ BT tests. Note that the Vg-Id characteristics of the thin film transistors before the ⁇ BT tests are almost the same as those before the +BT tests; thus, they are not shown in the graphs.
- FIGS. 41A to 41C it is found that as compared to the threshold voltages of the initial characteristics 711 , 721 , and 731 , the threshold voltages of the +BTs 712 , 722 , and 732 are shifted in the plus direction, and the threshold voltages of the ⁇ BTs 713 , 723 , and 733 are shifted in the minus direction.
- the shift amount at 350° C. of FIG. 41B is smaller than that at 250° C. of FIG. 41A and that the shift amount at 450° C. of FIG. 41C is smaller than that at 350° C. of FIG. 41B . That is, the higher the temperature of heat treatment which is performed before formation of a source and a drain is made, the smaller the amount of shift in the threshold voltage after +BT tests becomes.
- the temperature of heat treatment at 450° C. or higher can improve reliability in at least the +BT tests. It is found that there is a relation between elimination of impurities such as moisture (H 2 O) from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film and the results of the BT stress tests.
- the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b in contact with the semiconductor layer 403 which is an oxide semiconductor layer is formed using one or more materials selected from titanium, aluminum, manganese, magnesium, zirconium, and beryllium. Further, an alloy film including these elements in combination, and the like, may be stacked.
- the semiconductor layer 403 including a channel formation region may be formed using an oxide material having semiconductor characteristics. Typically, an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is used.
- FIGS. 6A to 6D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of the thin film transistor 470 .
- the gate electrode layer 401 is provided over the substrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface.
- An insulating film serving as a base film may be provided between the substrate 400 and the gate electrode layer 401 .
- the base film has a function of preventing diffusion of an impurity element from the substrate 400 , and can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using one or more of a silicon nitride film, a silicon oxide film, a silicon nitride oxide film, and a silicon oxynitride film.
- the gate electrode layer 401 can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using a metal material such as molybdenum, titanium, chromium, tantalum, tungsten, aluminum, copper, neodymium, or scandium, or an alloy material which contains any of these materials as its main component.
- a metal material such as molybdenum, titanium, chromium, tantalum, tungsten, aluminum, copper, neodymium, or scandium, or an alloy material which contains any of these materials as its main component.
- the following structures are preferable: a two-layer structure of an aluminum layer and a molybdenum layer stacked thereover, a two-layer structure of a copper layer and a molybdenum layer stacked thereover, a two-layer structure of a copper layer and a titanium nitride layer or a tantalum nitride layer stacked thereover, and a two-layer structure of a titanium nitride layer and a molybdenum layer.
- a stacked layer of a tungsten layer or a tungsten nitride layer, an alloy of aluminum and silicon or an alloy of aluminum and titanium, and a titanium nitride layer or a titanium layer is preferable.
- the gate insulating layer 402 is formed over the gate electrode layer 401 .
- the gate insulating layer 402 can be formed to have a single layer of a silicon oxide layer, a silicon nitride layer, a silicon oxynitride layer, or a silicon nitride oxide layer or a stacked layer thereof by a plasma CVD method or a sputtering method.
- a silicon oxynitride layer may be formed by a plasma CVD method using SiH 4 , oxygen, and nitrogen as a deposition gas.
- an oxide semiconductor film is formed over the gate insulating layer 402 .
- dust on a surface of the gate insulating layer 402 is preferably removed by reverse sputtering in which an argon gas is introduced and plasma is generated.
- the reverse sputtering refers to a method in which, without application of a voltage to a target side, an RF power source is used for application of a voltage to a substrate side under an argon atmosphere and plasma is generated in the vicinity of the substrate to modify a surface.
- an argon atmosphere a nitrogen atmosphere, a helium atmosphere, or the like may be used.
- an argon atmosphere to which oxygen, N 2 O, or the like is added may be used.
- an argon atmosphere to which Cl 2 , CF 4 , or the like is added may be used.
- the oxide semiconductor film is formed by a sputtering method with use of an In-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor target.
- the oxide semiconductor film can be formed by a sputtering method under a rare gas (typically, argon) atmosphere, an oxygen atmosphere, or an atmosphere of a rare gas (typically, argon) and oxygen.
- the gate insulating layer 402 and the oxide semiconductor film may be formed successively without exposure to air. Successive film formation without exposure to air makes it possible to obtain an interface of stacked layers, which are not contaminated by atmospheric components or impurity elements floating in air, such as moisture or hydrocarbon. Therefore, variation in characteristics of the thin film transistor can be reduced.
- the oxide semiconductor film is processed into an island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer 430 (a first oxide semiconductor layer) by a photolithography step (see FIG. 6A ).
- Heat treatment is performed on the oxide semiconductor layer under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure, and then, slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere (see FIG. 6B ).
- an inert gas such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon
- slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere (see FIG. 6B ).
- nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon it is preferable that moisture, hydrogen, and the like be not contained in nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon.
- nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon introduced into an apparatus for heat treatment have purity of 6N (99.9999%) or more, preferably, 7N (99.99999%) or more; that is, an impurity concentration is set to 1 ppm or lower, preferably, 0.1 ppm or lower.
- an instantaneous heating method can be employed, such as a heating method using an electric furnace, a GRTA (gas rapid thermal anneal) method using a heated gas, or an LRTA (Lamp Rapid Thermal Anneal) method using lamp light.
- a heating method using an electric furnace such as a GRTA (gas rapid thermal anneal) method using a heated gas, or an LRTA (Lamp Rapid Thermal Anneal) method using lamp light.
- GRTA gas rapid thermal anneal
- LRTA Low Rapid Thermal Anneal
- a heating method using an electric furnace 601 is described with reference to FIG. 14 as one mode of heat treatment of the oxide semiconductor layer 430 .
- FIG. 14 is a schematic view of the electric furnace 601 .
- Heaters 603 are provided outside a chamber 602 , which heats the chamber 602 .
- a susceptor 605 in which a substrate 604 is mounted is provided inside the chamber 602 .
- the substrate 604 is transferred into/from the chamber 602 .
- the chamber 602 is provided with a gas supply means 606 and an evacuation means 607 .
- a gas is introduced into the chamber 602 .
- the evacuation means 607 exhausts the inside of the chamber 602 or reduces the pressure in the chamber 602 .
- the temperature rising characteristics of the electric furnace is preferably set to from 0.1° C./min to 20° C./min.
- the temperature decreasing characteristics of the electric furnace is preferably set to from 0.1° C./min to 15° C./min.
- the gas supply means 606 includes a gas supply source 611 , a pressure adjusting valve 612 , a refining apparatus 613 , a mass flow controller 614 , and a stop valve 615 .
- the refining apparatus 613 be provided between the gas supply source 611 and the chamber 602 .
- the refining apparatus 613 can remove impurities such as moisture and hydrogen in a gas which is introduced from the gas supply source 611 into the chamber 602 ; thus, entry into the chamber 602 , of moisture, hydrogen, and the like, can be suppressed by provision of the refining apparatus 613 .
- nitrogen or a rare gas is introduced into the chamber 602 from the gas supply source 611 , so that the inside of the chamber 602 is in a nitrogen or a rare gas atmosphere.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 430 formed over the substrate 604 is heated, whereby the oxide semiconductor layer 430 can be dehydrated or dehydrogenated.
- the chamber 602 in which the pressure is reduced by the evacuation means is heated at from 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably, from 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 430 formed over the substrate 604 is heated, whereby the oxide semiconductor layer 430 can be dehydrated or dehydrogenated.
- the heaters are turned off, and the chamber 602 of the heating apparatus is gradually cooled.
- resistance of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher), so that a low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 431 (a second oxide semiconductor layer) can be formed.
- an inert gas may be discharged after the heat treatment, so that the chamber is to be under an atmospheric pressure, and then, cooling may be performed.
- the substrate 604 in the chamber 602 of the heating apparatus After the substrate 604 in the chamber 602 of the heating apparatus is cooled to 300° C., the substrate 604 may be transferred into an atmosphere at room temperature. As a result, the cooling time of the substrate 604 can be shortened.
- heat treatment and cool treatment can be performed in chambers different from each other.
- an oxide semiconductor layer over a substrate is heated in a first chamber which is filled with nitrogen or a rare gas and heated at from 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably from 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive.
- the substrate subjected to heat treatment is transferred, through a transfer chamber in which nitrogen or a rare gas is introduced, into a second chamber which is filled with nitrogen or a rare gas and heated at 100° C. or lower, preferably at room temperature, and then cooling treatment is performed therein.
- throughput can be increased.
- the heat treatment of the oxide semiconductor layer under an inert-gas atmosphere or reduced pressure may be performed on the oxide semiconductor film which has not yet been processed into the island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer.
- slow cooling is performed to the temperature equal to or higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C. Then, the substrate is taken out from the heating apparatus, and a photolithography step is performed.
- the oxide semiconductor film which has been subjected to heat treatment under an inert-gas atmosphere or reduced pressure is preferably an amorphous film, but a part thereof may be crystallized.
- a conductive film is formed over the gate insulating layer 402 and the oxide semiconductor layer 431 .
- an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, Mo, and W; an alloy containing any of the above elements as its component; an alloy film containing a combination of any of the above elements; and the like can be given.
- the conductive film preferably has heat resistance enough to withstand the heat treatment. Since use of Al alone brings disadvantages such as low resistance and a tendency to be corroded, aluminum is used in combination with a conductive material having heat resistance.
- a conductive material having heat resistance which is used in combination with Al any of the following materials may be used: an element selected from titanium (Ti), tantalum (Ta), tungsten (W), molybdenum (Mo), chromium (Cr), neodymium (Nd), and scandium (Sc), an alloy containing any of these above elements as a component, an alloy containing these elements in combination, and a nitride containing any of these above elements as a component.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 431 and the conductive film are etched in an etching step, so that an oxide semiconductor layer 432 and the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b are formed (see FIG. 6C ). Note that the oxide semiconductor layer 432 is partly etched so as to have a groove (a depressed portion).
- the oxide insulating film 407 is formed by a sputtering method so as to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer 432 .
- the oxide insulating film 407 which is formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer does not contain impurities such as moisture, a hydrogen ion, and OH ⁇ and is formed using an inorganic insulating film which prevents the impurities from entering from the outside. Specifically, a silicon oxide film or a silicon nitride oxide is used.
- the oxide insulating film 407 a 300-nm-thick silicon oxide film is formed.
- the substrate temperature in film formation may be from room temperature to 300° C. or lower and in this embodiment, is 100° C.
- the formation of the silicon oxide film by a sputtering method can be performed under a rare gas (typically, argon) atmosphere, an oxygen atmosphere, or an atmosphere of a rare gas (typically, argon) and oxygen.
- a silicon oxide target or a silicon target may be used as a target.
- a silicon oxide film can be formed by a sputtering method under an atmosphere of oxygen and nitrogen.
- the oxide insulating film 407 is formed by a sputtering method, a PCVD method, or the like to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 432 , in the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 432 , at least a region in contact with the oxide insulating film 407 have increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 ). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 432 becomes the semiconductor layer 403 having a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region (a third oxide semiconductor layer), and then, the thin film transistor 470 can be completed (see FIG. 6D ).
- Impurities (such as H 2 O, H, and OH) contained in the oxide semiconductor layer are reduced by performance of the heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, and the carrier concentration is increased. After that, slow cooling is performed. Then, formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer, or the like, is performed, so that the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced. Thus, reliability of the thin film transistor 470 can be improved.
- heat treatment may be performed on the thin film transistor 470 , under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air) at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably.
- heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. is performed for one hour.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 432 in a condition of being in contact with the oxide insulating film 407 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of the thin film transistor 470 can be reduced.
- this heat treatment at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably
- this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing.
- FIGS. 8A to 8D and FIGS. 9A and 9B A semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to FIGS. 8A to 8D and FIGS. 9A and 9B .
- the same portion as or a portion having functions similar to those described in Embodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described in Embodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted.
- FIG. 9A is a top view of a thin film transistor 460 included in a semiconductor device
- FIG. 9B is a cross-sectional view along line D 1 -D 2 of FIG. 9A
- the thin film transistor 460 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over a substrate 450 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, a gate electrode layer 451 , a gate insulating layer 452 , source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b, and a semiconductor layer 453 .
- an oxide insulating film 457 is provided so as to cover the thin film transistor 460 and be in contact with the semiconductor layer 453 .
- an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is used for the semiconductor layer 453 .
- the gate insulating layer 452 exists throughout the region including the thin film transistor 460 , and the gate electrode layer 451 is provided between the gate insulating layer 452 and the substrate 450 which is a substrate having an insulating surface.
- the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b are provided over the gate insulating layer 452 .
- the semiconductor layer 453 is provided over the gate insulating layer 452 and the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b.
- a wiring layer is provided over the gate insulating layer 452 , and the wiring layer extends beyond the peripheral portion of the semiconductor layer 453 .
- the semiconductor layer 453 formed using an oxide semiconductor film is subjected to heat treatment (heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation) for reducing impurities such as moisture and the like at least after formation of the oxide semiconductor film, so that resistance is reduced (the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher).
- the oxide insulating film 457 is formed to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor film, so that the oxide semiconductor film has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 ). Accordingly, the oxide semiconductor film can be used as a channel formation region.
- the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced by formation of an oxide insulating film to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer or the like, which improves reliability of the thin film transistor 460 .
- the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b in contact with the semiconductor layer 453 which is an oxide semiconductor layer is formed using one or more materials selected from titanium, aluminum, manganese, magnesium, zirconium, and beryllium.
- FIGS. 8A to 8D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of the thin film transistor 460 .
- the gate electrode layer 451 is provided over the substrate 450 which is a substrate having an insulating surface.
- An insulating film serving as a base film may be provided between the substrate 450 and the gate electrode layer 451 .
- the base film has a function of preventing diffusion of an impurity element from the substrate 450 , and can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using one or more of a silicon nitride film, a silicon oxide film, a silicon nitride oxide film, and a silicon oxynitride film.
- the gate electrode layer 451 can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using a metal material selected from molybdenum, titanium, chromium, tantalum, tungsten, aluminum, copper, neodymium, and scandium, or an alloy material which contains any of these materials as its main component.
- a metal material selected from molybdenum, titanium, chromium, tantalum, tungsten, aluminum, copper, neodymium, and scandium, or an alloy material which contains any of these materials as its main component.
- the gate insulating layer 452 is formed over the gate electrode layer 451 .
- the gate insulating layer 452 can be formed by a plasma CVD method or a sputtering method to have a single layer of a silicon oxide layer, a silicon nitride layer, a silicon oxynitride layer, or a silicon nitride oxide layer or a stacked layer thereof.
- a conductive film is formed and patterned into island-shaped source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b by a photolithography step ( FIG. 8A ).
- the material of the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b there are an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, Mo, and W, an alloy including any of these elements as its component, an alloy including a combination of any of these elements, and the like. Further, an alloy film including these elements in combination, and the like, may be stacked.
- the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b are preferably formed using a molybdenum film having high heat resistance enough to withstand heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation performed later.
- an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, and W, an alloy including any of the above elements, an alloy film including these elements in combination, and the like may be stacked over the molybdenum film.
- an oxide semiconductor film is formed over the gate insulating layer 452 and the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b, and patterned into an island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer 483 (a first oxide semiconductor layer) by a photolithography step ( FIG. 8B ).
- the oxide semiconductor layer 483 serves as a channel formation region and is thus formed in a manner similar to the first oxide semiconductor film in Embodiment 1.
- dust attached to a surface of the gate insulating layer 452 is preferably removed by reverse sputtering in which an argon gas is introduced and plasma is generated.
- Heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed on the oxide semiconductor layer 483 , and then, slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere.
- heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation heat treatment is performed under an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) atmosphere or under reduced pressure at temperature of from 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably, from 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive.
- resistance of the oxide semiconductor layer 483 is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher), so that a low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 484 (a second oxide semiconductor layer) can be obtained (see FIG. 8C ).
- nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon it is preferable that moisture, hydrogen, and the like be not contained in nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon.
- nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon introduced into an apparatus for heat treatment have purity of 6N (99.9999%) or more, preferably, 7N (99.99999%) or more; that is, an impurity concentration is set to 1 ppm or lower, preferably, 0.1 ppm or lower.
- the heat treatment of the oxide semiconductor layer under an inert-gas atmosphere or under reduced pressure may be performed on the oxide semiconductor film which has not yet been processed into the island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer.
- slow cooling is performed to the temperature equal to or higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C. Then, the substrate is taken out from the heating apparatus, and a photolithography step is performed.
- the oxide insulating film 457 is formed by a sputtering method or a PCVD method to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer 484 .
- a 300-nm-thick silicon oxide film is formed as the oxide insulating film 457 .
- the substrate temperature in film formation may be from room temperature to 300° C. or lower and in this embodiment, is 100° C.
- the oxide insulating film 457 is formed by a sputtering method to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 484 , in the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 484 , at least a region in contact with the oxide insulating film 457 which is a silicon oxide film have increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 ). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 484 becomes the semiconductor layer 453 having the high-resistance oxide semiconductor region (a third oxide semiconductor layer), and then, the thin film transistor 460 can be completed (see FIG. 8D ).
- Impurities (such as H 2 O, H, and OH) contained in the oxide semiconductor layer are reduced by performance of heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, and the carrier concentration is increased. After that, slow cooling is performed. Then, formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer, or the like, is performed, so that the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced. Thus, reliability of the thin film transistor 460 can be improved.
- heat treatment may be performed on the thin film transistor 460 , under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air) at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably.
- heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for one hour.
- the semiconductor layer 453 in a condition being in contact with the oxide insulating film 457 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of the thin film transistor 460 can be reduced.
- this heat treatment at equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably
- this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing.
- Embodiment 1 can be freely combined with Embodiment 1.
- FIGS. 10A to 10D A manufacturing process of a semiconductor device including a thin film transistor will be described with reference to FIGS. 10A to 10D , FIGS. 11A to 11C , FIG. 12 , and FIGS. 13 A 1 , 13 A 2 , 13 B 1 , and 13 B 2 .
- a substrate 100 having a light-transmitting property a glass substrate of barium borosilicate glass, aluminoborosilicate glass, or the like can be used.
- a conductive layer is formed over an entire surface of the substrate 100 , and then a first photolithography step is performed.
- a resist mask is formed, and then an unnecessary portion is removed by etching, so that wirings and electrodes (a gate wiring including a gate electrode layer 101 , a capacitor wiring 108 , and a first terminal 121 ) are formed.
- the etching is performed so that at least end portions of the gate electrode layer 101 have a tapered shape.
- Each of the gate wiring including the gate electrode layer 101 , the capacitor wiring 108 , and the first terminal 121 at a terminal portion is preferably formed using a heat-resistant conductive material such as an element selected from titanium (Ti), tantalum (Ta), tungsten (W), molybdenum (Mo), chromium (Cr), neodymium (Nd), and scandium (Sc); an alloy containing any of these elements as its component; an alloy film containing a combination of any of these elements; or a nitride containing any of these elements as its component.
- a heat-resistant conductive material such as an element selected from titanium (Ti), tantalum (Ta), tungsten (W), molybdenum (Mo), chromium (Cr), neodymium (Nd), and scandium (Sc); an alloy containing any of these elements as its component; an alloy film containing a combination of any of these elements; or a nitride containing any of these elements
- a gate insulating layer 102 is formed over the entire surface of the gate electrode layer 101 .
- the gate insulating layer 102 is formed to a thickness of 50 to 250 nm by a PCVD method, a sputtering method, or the like.
- a silicon oxide film is formed to a thickness of 100 nm by a sputtering method.
- the gate insulating layer 102 is not necessarily formed using such a silicon oxide film and may be formed to have a single-layer structure or a stacked-layer structure using another insulating film: a silicon oxynitride film, a silicon nitride film, an aluminum oxide film, a tantalum oxide film, and the like.
- an oxide semiconductor film (an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film) is formed over the gate insulating layer 102 . It is effective to form the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film without exposure to air after the plasma treatment because dust and moisture do not adhere to the interface between the gate insulating layer and the semiconductor film.
- a pulse direct current (DC) power supply is preferable because dust can be reduced and the film thickness can be uniform.
- the second In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is formed to have a thickness of 5 nm to 200 nm.
- As the oxide semiconductor film a 50-nm-thick In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is formed by a sputtering method using an In-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor target.
- Examples of a sputtering method include an RF sputtering method in which a high-frequency power source is used as a sputtering power source, a DC sputtering method, and a pulsed DC sputtering method in which a bias is applied in a pulsed manner.
- An RF sputtering method is mainly used in the case where an insulating film is formed, and a DC sputtering method is mainly used in the case where a metal film is formed.
- multi-source sputtering apparatus in which a plurality of targets of different materials can be set.
- films of different materials can be formed to be stacked in the same chamber, or a film of plural kinds of materials can be deposited by electric discharge at the same time in the same chamber.
- a sputtering apparatus provided with a magnet system inside the chamber and used for a magnetron sputtering, and a sputtering apparatus used for an ECR sputtering in which plasma generated with the use of microwaves is used without using glow discharge.
- a deposition method using sputtering there are also a reactive sputtering method in which a target substance and a sputtering gas component are chemically reacted with each other during deposition to form a thin compound film thereof, and a bias sputtering in which a voltage is also applied to a substrate during deposition.
- a second photolithography step is performed.
- a resist mask is formed, and then the oxide semiconductor film is etched.
- unnecessary portions are removed by wet etching using a mixed solution of phosphoric acid, acetic acid, and nitric acid, so that an oxide semiconductor layer 133 is formed (see FIG. 10A ).
- etching here is not limited to wet etching but dry etching may also be performed.
- etching gas for dry etching a gas containing chlorine (chlorine-based gas such as chlorine (Cl 2 ), boron chloride (BCl 3 ), silicon chloride (SiCl 4 ), or carbon tetrachloride (CCl 4 )) is preferably used.
- a gas containing fluorine fluorine-based gas such as carbon tetrafluoride (CF 4 ), sulfur fluoride (SF 6 ), nitrogen fluoride (NF 3 ), or trifluoromethane (CHF 3 )); hydrogen bromide (HBr); oxygen (O 2 ); any of these gases to which a rare gas such as helium (He) or argon (Ar) is added; or the like can be used.
- fluorine-based gas such as carbon tetrafluoride (CF 4 ), sulfur fluoride (SF 6 ), nitrogen fluoride (NF 3 ), or trifluoromethane (CHF 3 )
- hydrogen bromide HBr
- oxygen O 2
- any of these gases to which a rare gas such as helium (He) or argon (Ar) is added; or the like can be used.
- a parallel plate RIE (reactive ion etching) method or an ICP (inductively coupled plasma) etching method can be used.
- the etching condition the amount of electric power applied to a coil-shaped electrode, the amount of electric power applied to an electrode on a substrate side, the temperature of the electrode on the substrate side, or the like.
- etchant used for wet etching a solution obtained by mixing phosphoric acid, acetic acid, and nitric acid, or the like can be used.
- ITO07N produced by KANTO CHEMICAL CO., INC.
- KANTO CHEMICAL CO., INC. may also be used.
- the etchant used in the wet etching is removed by cleaning together with the material which is etched off. Waste liquid of the etchant containing the removed materials may be purified to recycle the materials contained in the waste liquid.
- a material such as indium included in the oxide semiconductor layer is collected from the waste liquid after the etching and reused, the resources can be efficiently used and the cost can be reduced.
- the etching conditions (such as an etchant, etching time, and temperature) are appropriately adjusted depending on the material so that the material can be etched into a desired shape.
- heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed on the oxide semiconductor layer 133 .
- an inert gas such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon
- slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere.
- Heat treatment is preferably performed at a temperature of 200° C. or higher. For example, heat treatment is performed for 1 hour at 450° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. By the heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere, resistance of the oxide semiconductor layer 133 is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher), which results in increase of conductivity of the oxide semiconductor layer 133 . Therefore, a low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 134 is formed (see FIG. 10B ). Preferable electrical conductivity of the oxide semiconductor layer 134 is from 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 1 S/cm to 1 ⁇ 10 2 S/cm inclusive.
- a conductive film 132 is formed using a metal material over the oxide semiconductor layer 134 by a sputtering method or a vacuum evaporation method (see FIG. 10C ).
- an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, Mo, and W, an alloy containing any of these elements as a component, an alloy film containing these elements in combination, and the like can be given.
- the conductive film When heat treatment is performed after the conductive film 132 is formed, the conductive film preferably has heat resistance enough to withstand this heat resistance.
- a third photolithography step is performed.
- a resist mask is formed, and unnecessary portions are removed, so that source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b, and a second terminal 122 are formed (see FIG. 10D ).
- Wet etching or dry etching is employed as an etching method at this time. For example, when an aluminum film or an aluminum-alloy film is used as the conductive film 132 , wet etching using a mixed solution of phosphoric acid, acetic acid, and nitric acid can be carried out.
- the conductive film 132 is etched to form the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b.
- an exposed region of the oxide semiconductor layer 134 is also partly etched to form a semiconductor layer 135 .
- a region of the semiconductor layer 135 which lies between the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b has a small thickness.
- etching of the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b and the semiconductor layer 135 are simultaneously conducted using dry etching; therefore, the end portions of the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b are aligned with the end portions of the semiconductor layer 135 , so that a continuous structure is provided.
- the second terminal 122 which is formed from the same material as the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b is left in a terminal portion. Note that the second terminal 122 is electrically connected to a source wiring (a source wiring including the source or drain electrode layers 105 a or 105 b ).
- the number of resist masks can be reduced, resulting in simplified process and lower costs.
- a protective insulating layer 107 is formed to cover the gate insulating layer 102 , the oxide semiconductor layer 135 , and the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b.
- the protective insulating layer 107 is formed using a silicon oxynitride film by a PCVD method.
- a region in contact with the protective insulating layer 107 has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 ).
- the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 .
- Heat treatment may be performed under an oxygen atmosphere before formation of the protective insulating layer 107 .
- the heat treatment under an oxygen atmosphere may be performed at a temperature higher than or equal to 150° C. and lower than 350° C.
- Heat treatment may be performed after formation of the protective insulating layer 107 .
- the heat treatment may be performed under an air atmosphere or a nitrogen atmosphere at a temperature higher than or equal to 150° C. and lower than 350° C.
- the semiconductor layer 103 in a condition being in contact with the oxide insulating layer 107 is heated, which leads to increase in resistance of the semiconductor layer 103 ; thus, electric characteristics of the transistor can be improved and variation in electric characteristics can be reduced.
- this heat treatment at equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably
- this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing.
- a thin film transistor 170 can be completed.
- a fourth photolithography step is performed.
- a resist mask is formed, and the protective insulating layer 107 and the gate insulating layer 102 are etched to form a contact hole 125 that reaches the drain electrode layer 105 b.
- a contact hole 127 reaching the second terminal 122 and a contact hole 126 reaching the first terminal 121 are also formed in the same etching step.
- a cross-sectional view at this stage is illustrated in FIG. 11B .
- the transparent conductive film is formed of indium oxide (In 2 O 3 ), indium oxide-tin oxide alloy (In 2 O 3 —SnO 2 , abbreviated to ITO), or the like by a sputtering method, a vacuum evaporation method, or the like. Such a material is etched with a hydrochloric acid-based solution. However, since a residue is easily generated particularly in etching ITO, indium oxide-zinc oxide alloy (In 2 O 3 —ZnO) may be used to improve etching processability. Further, when heat treatment for reducing resistance of the transparent conductive film, the heat treatment can serve as heat treatment for increasing resistance of the semiconductor layer 103 , which results in improvement of electric characteristics of the transistor and reduction of variation in the electric characteristics thereof.
- a fifth photolithography step is performed.
- a resist mask is formed, and an unnecessary portion of the transparent conductive film is removed by etching to form a pixel electrode layer 110 .
- a storage capacitor is formed with the capacitor wiring 108 and the pixel electrode layer 110 , in which the gate insulating layer 102 and the protective insulating layer 107 in the capacitor portion are used as a dielectric.
- the first terminal 121 and the second terminal 122 are covered with the resist mask, and transparent conductive films 128 and 129 are left in the terminal portions.
- the transparent conductive films 128 and 129 function as electrodes or wirings connected to an FPC.
- the transparent conductive film 128 formed over the first terminal 121 is a connecting terminal electrode serving as an input terminal of a gate wiring.
- the transparent conductive film 129 formed over the second terminal 122 is a connection terminal electrode which functions as an input terminal of the source wiring.
- FIG. 11C A cross-sectional view at this stage is illustrated in FIG. 11C . Note that a plan view at this stage corresponds to FIG. 12 .
- FIGS. 13 A 1 and 13 A 2 are respectively a cross-sectional view and a top view of a gate wiring terminal portion at this stage.
- FIG. 13 A 1 is a cross-sectional view taken along line C 1 -C 2 of FIG. 13 A 2 .
- a transparent conductive film 155 formed over a protective insulating layer 154 is a connection terminal electrode which functions as an input terminal.
- a first terminal 151 made of the same material as the gate wiring and a connection electrode layer 153 made of the same material as the source wiring overlap each other with a gate insulating layer 152 interposed therebetween, and are electrically connected to each other through the transparent conductive film 155 .
- FIG. 11C where the transparent conductive film 128 is in contact with the first terminal 121 corresponds to a part of FIG. 13 A 1 where the transparent conductive film 155 is in contact with the first terminal 151 .
- FIGS. 13 B 1 and 13 B 2 are respectively a cross-sectional view and a top view of a source wiring terminal portion which is different from that illustrated in FIG. 11C .
- FIG. 13 B 1 corresponds to a cross-sectional view taken along line F 1 -F 2 of FIG. 13 B 2 .
- a transparent conductive film 155 formed over a protective insulating layer 154 is a connection terminal electrode which functions as an input terminal.
- an electrode layer 156 formed from the same material as the gate wiring is located below and overlapped with a second terminal 150 , which is electrically connected to the source wiring, with a gate insulating layer 152 interposed therebetween.
- the electrode layer 156 is not electrically connected to the second terminal 150 , and a capacitor to prevent noise or static electricity can be formed if the potential of the electrode layer 156 is set to a potential different from that of the second terminal 150 , such as floating, GND, or 0 V.
- the second terminal 150 is electrically connected to the transparent conductive film 155 through the protective insulating layer 154 .
- a plurality of gate wirings, source wirings, and capacitor wirings are provided depending on the pixel density. Also in the terminal portion, a plurality of first terminals at the same potential as the gate wiring, a plurality of second terminals at the same potential as the source wiring, a plurality of third terminals at the same potential as the capacitor wiring, and the like are arranged.
- the number of each of the terminals may be any number, and the number of the terminals may be determined by a practitioner as appropriate.
- the storage capacitor and a pixel thin film transistor portion including the thin film transistor 170 which is a bottom-gate staggered thin film transistor can be completed using the five photomasks.
- the thin film transistor and the storage capacitor By disposing the thin film transistor and the storage capacitor in each pixel of a pixel portion in which pixels are arranged in a matrix form, one of substrates for manufacturing an active matrix display device can be obtained. In this specification, such a substrate is referred to as an active matrix substrate for convenience.
- an active matrix substrate and a counter substrate provided with a counter electrode are bonded to each other with a liquid crystal layer interposed therebetween.
- a common electrode electrically connected to the counter electrode on the counter substrate is provided over the active matrix substrate, and a fourth terminal electrically connected to the common electrode is provided in the terminal portion.
- the fourth terminal is provided so that the common electrode is set to a fixed potential such as GND or 0 V.
- the pixel electrode may be overlapped with a gate wiring of an adjacent pixel with the protective insulating layer and the gate insulating layer interposed therebetween, so that a storage capacitor is formed.
- pixel electrodes arranged in a matrix form are driven to form a display pattern on a screen. Specifically, voltage is applied between a selected pixel electrode and a counter electrode corresponding to the pixel electrode, so that a liquid crystal layer provided between the pixel electrode and the counter electrode is optically modulated and this optical modulation is recognized as a display pattern by an observer.
- a liquid crystal display device In displaying moving images, a liquid crystal display device has a problem that a long response time of liquid crystal molecules themselves causes afterimages or blurring of moving images.
- a driving method called black insertion is employed in which black is displayed on the whole screen every other frame period.
- a driving method called double-frame rate driving may be employed in which a vertical synchronizing frequency is 1.5 times or more, preferably, 2 times or more as high as a usual vertical synchronizing frequency to improve the moving-image characteristics.
- a driving method in which a plurality of LEDs (light-emitting diodes) or a plurality of EL light sources are used to form a surface light source as a backlight, and each light source of the surface light source is independently driven in a pulsed manner in one frame period.
- the surface light source three or more kinds of LEDs may be used and an LED emitting white light may be used. Since a plurality of LEDs can be controlled independently, the light emission timing of LEDs can be synchronized with the timing at which a liquid crystal layer is optically modulated. According to this driving method, LEDs can be partly turned off; therefore, an effect of reducing power consumption can be obtained particularly in the case of displaying an image having a large part on which black is displayed.
- the display characteristics of a liquid crystal display device such as moving-image characteristics, can be improved as compared to those of conventional liquid crystal display devices.
- the n-channel transistor disclosed in this specification includes an oxide semiconductor film which is used for a channel formation region and has excellent dynamic characteristics; thus, it can be combined with these driving techniques.
- one electrode (also referred to as a cathode) of an organic light-emitting element is set to a low power supply potential such as GND or 0 V; thus, a terminal portion is provided with a fourth terminal for setting the cathode to a low power supply potential such as GND or 0 V.
- a power supply line is provided in addition to a source wiring and a gate wiring. Accordingly, the terminal portion is provided with a fifth terminal electrically connected to the power supply line.
- a partition formed using an organic resin layer may be provided between organic light-emitting elements in some cases.
- the organic resin layer is subjected to heat treatment, and the heat treatment can serve as heat treatment for improvement of electric characteristics and reduction of variation in electric characteristics of the transistor by increasing resistance of the semiconductor layer 103 .
- an oxide semiconductor for a thin film transistor leads to reduction in manufacturing cost.
- impurities such as moisture are reduced for increasing purity of the oxide semiconductor film by heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, it is not necessary to use a ultrapure oxide semiconductor target and a special sputtering apparatus provided with a deposition chamber whose dew point is lowered.
- a semiconductor device including a highly reliable thin film transistor with excellent electric characteristics can be manufactured.
- the channel formation region in the semiconductor layer is a high-resistance region; thus, electric characteristics of the thin film transistor are stabilized and increase in off current can be prevented. Therefore, a semiconductor device including a thin film transistor having high electric characteristics and high reliability can be provided.
- a display device which is one example of a semiconductor device will be described.
- the display device at least a part of a driver circuit and a thin film transistor to be disposed in a pixel portion are formed over one substrate.
- the thin film transistor in the pixel portion is formed according to any of Embodiments 1 to 3.
- the thin film transistor described in any of Embodiments 1 to 3 is an n-channel TFT; therefore, part of a driver circuit which can be formed using an n-channel TFT is formed over the same substrate as the thin film transistor of the pixel portion.
- FIG. 20A illustrates an example of a block diagram of an active matrix liquid crystal display device, which is an example of a semiconductor device.
- the display device illustrated in FIG. 20A includes, over a substrate 5300 , a pixel portion 5301 including a plurality of pixels each provided with a display element, a scan line driver circuit 5302 that selects a pixel, and a signal line driver circuit 5303 that controls a video signal input to a selected pixel.
- the pixel portion 5301 is connected to the signal line driver circuit 5303 by a plurality of signal lines S 1 to Sm (not shown) which extend in a column direction from the signal line driver circuit 5303 , and to the scan line driver circuit 5302 by a plurality of scan lines G 1 to Gn (not shown) that extend in a row direction from the scan line driver circuit 5302 . Then, each pixel is connected to a signal line Sj (any one of the signal lines S 1 to Sm) and a scan line G 1 (any one of the scan lines G 1 to Gn).
- the thin film transistor described in each of Embodiments 1 to 3 is an n-channel TFT, and a signal line driver circuit including the n-channel TFT is described with reference to FIG. 21 .
- the signal line driver circuit illustrated in FIG. 21 includes a driver IC 5601 , switch groups 5602 _ 1 to 5602 _M, a first wiring 5611 , a second wiring 5612 , a third wiring 5613 , and wirings 5621 _ 1 to 5621 _M.
- Each of the switch groups 5602 _ 1 to 5602 _M includes a first thin film transistor 5603 a, a second thin film transistor 5603 b, and a third thin film transistor 5603 c.
- the driver IC 5601 is connected to the first wiring 5611 , the second wiring 5612 , the third wiring 5613 , and the wirings 5621 _ 1 to 5621 _M.
- Each of the switch groups 5602 _ 1 to 5602 _M is connected to the first wiring 5611 , the second wiring 5612 , and the third wiring 5613 , and the wirings 5621 _ 1 to 5621 _M are connected to the switch groups 5602 _ 1 to 5602 _M, respectively.
- Each of the wirings 5621 _ 1 to 5621 _M is connected to three signal lines via the first thin film transistor 5603 a, the second thin film transistor 5603 b, and the third thin film transistor 5603 c.
- the wiring 5621 _J of the J-th column (one of the wirings 5621 _ 1 to 5621 _M) is connected to a signal line Sj ⁇ 1, a signal line Sj, and a signal line Sj+1 via the first thin film transistor 5603 a, the second thin film transistor 5603 b, and the third thin film transistor 5603 c which are included in the switch group 5602 _J.
- a signal is input to each of the first wiring 5611 , the second wiring 5612 , and the third wiring 5613 .
- the driver IC 5601 is preferably formed over a single crystalline substrate. Further, the switch groups 5602 _ 1 to 5602 _M are preferably formed over the same substrate as the pixel portion. Therefore, the driver IC 5601 and the switch groups 5602 _ 1 to 5602 _M are preferably connected through an FPC or the like.
- FIG. 22 illustrates the timing chart where a scan line Gi of the i-th row is selected.
- a selection period of the scan line Gi of the i-th row is divided into a first sub-selection period T 1 , a second sub-selection period T 2 , and a third sub-selection period T 3 .
- the signal line driver circuit in FIG. 21 operates similarly to that in FIG. 22 even when a scan line of another row is selected.
- the timing chart in FIG. 22 shows the case where the wiring 5621 _J of the J-th column is connected to the signal line Sj ⁇ 1, the signal line Sj, and the signal line Sj+1 through the first thin film transistor 5603 a, the second thin film transistor 5603 b, and the third thin film transistor 5603 c.
- the timing chart of FIG. 22 shows timing when the scan line Gi of the i-th row is selected, timing 5703 a when the first thin film transistor 5603 a is turned on/off, timing 5703 b when the second thin film transistor 5603 b is turned on/off, timing 5703 c when the third thin film transistor 5603 c is turned on/off, and a signal 5721 _J input to the wiring 5621 _J of the J-th column.
- different video signals are input to the wirings 5621 _ 1 to 5621 _M.
- a video signal input to the wiring 5621 _J in the first sub-selection period T 1 is input to the signal line Sj ⁇ 1
- a video signal input to the wiring 5621 _J in the second sub-selection period T 2 is input to the signal line Sj
- a video signal input to the wiring 5621 _J in the third sub-selection period T 3 is input to the signal line Sj+1.
- the video signals input to the wiring 5621 _J in the first sub-selection period T 1 , the second sub-selection period T 2 , and the third sub-selection period T 3 are denoted by Data_j ⁇ 1, Data_j, and Data_j+1.
- the first thin film transistor 5603 a is turned on, and the second thin film transistor 5603 b and the third thin film transistor 5603 c are turned off.
- Data_j ⁇ 1 input to the wiring 5621 _J is input to the signal line Sj ⁇ 1 via the first thin film transistor 5603 a.
- the second thin film transistor 5603 b is turned on, and the first thin film transistor 5603 a and the third thin film transistor 5603 c are turned off.
- Data_j input to the wiring 5621 _J is input to the signal line Sj via the second thin film transistor 5603 b.
- the third thin film transistor 5603 c is turned on, and the first thin film transistor 5603 a and the second thin film transistor 5603 b are turned off.
- Data_j+1 input to the wiring 5621 _J is input to the signal line Sj+1 via the third thin film transistor 5603 c.
- the number of connections of the substrate provided with the driver IC 5601 and the substrate provided with the pixel portion can be approximately 1 ⁇ 3 of the number of signal lines.
- the number of connections is decreased to approximately 1 ⁇ 3 of the number of the signal lines, so that reliability, yield, etc., of the signal line driver circuit in FIG. 21 can be improved.
- one gate selection period is divided into four or more sub-selection periods, one sub-selection period becomes shorter. Therefore, one gate selection period is preferably divided into two or three sub-selection periods.
- one selection period may be divided into a pre-charge period Tp, the first sub-selection period T 1 , the second sub-selection period T 2 , and the third sub-selection period T 3 .
- the timing chart in FIG. 23 shows timing at which the scan line Gi of the i-th row is selected, timing 5803 a of on/off of the first thin transistor 5603 a, timing 5803 b of on/off of the second thin transistor 5603 b, timing 5803 c of on/off of the third thin transistor 5603 c, and a signal 5821 _J input to the wiring 5621 _J of the J-th column.
- FIG. 23 shows timing at which the scan line Gi of the i-th row is selected, timing 5803 a of on/off of the first thin transistor 5603 a, timing 5803 b of on/off of the second thin transistor 5603 b, timing 5803 c of on/off of the third thin transistor 5603 c, and a signal
- the first thin film transistor 5603 a, the second thin film transistor 5603 b, and the third thin film transistor 5603 c are turned on in the pre-charge period Tp.
- pre-charge voltage Vp input to the wiring 5621 _J is input to each of the signal line Sj ⁇ 1, the signal line Sj, and the signal line Sj+1 via the first thin film transistor 5603 a, the second thin film transistor 5603 b, and the third thin film transistor 5603 c.
- the first thin film transistor 5603 a is turned on, and the second thin film transistor 5603 b and the third thin film transistor 5603 c are turned off.
- Data_j ⁇ 1 input to the wiring 5621 _J is input to the signal line Sj ⁇ 1 via the first thin film transistor 5603 a.
- the second thin film transistor 5603 b is turned on, and the first thin film transistor 5603 a and the third thin film transistor 5603 c are turned off.
- Data_j input to the wiring 5621 _J is input to the signal line Sj via the second thin film transistor 5603 b.
- the third thin film transistor 5603 c is turned on, and the first thin film transistor 5603 a and the second thin film transistor 5603 b are turned off.
- Data_j+1 input to the wiring 5621 _J is input to the signal line Sj+1 via the third thin film transistor 5603 c.
- the signal line driver circuit of FIG. 21 to which the timing chart of FIG. 23 is applied, the signal line can be pre-charged by providing the pre-charge period before the sub-selection periods.
- a video signal can be written to a pixel with high speed.
- the scan line driver circuit includes a shift register.
- the scan line driver may be provided with a level shifter, a buffer, a switch, and the like as necessary, or may include only a shift register.
- CLK clock signal
- SP start pulse signal
- a selection signal is generated.
- the generated selection signal is buffered and amplified by the buffer, and the resulting signal is supplied to a corresponding scan line.
- Gate electrodes of transistors in pixels of one line are connected to the scan line. Since the transistors in the pixels of one line have to be turned on all at once, a buffer which can supply a large current is used.
- FIG. 24 shows a circuit configuration of the shift register.
- the shift register shown in FIG. 24 includes a plurality of flip-flops: flip-flops 5701 _ 1 to 5701 _n.
- the shift register operates with input of a first clock signal, a second clock signal, a start pulse signal, and a reset signal.
- a first wiring 5501 shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a seventh wiring 5717 _i ⁇ 1; a second wiring 5502 shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a seventh wiring 5717 _i+1; a third wiring 5503 shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a seventh wiring 5717 _i; and a sixth wiring 5506 shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a fifth wiring 5715 .
- a fourth wiring 5504 shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a second wiring 5712 in flip-flops of odd-numbered stages, and is connected to a third wiring 5713 in flip-flops of even-numbered stages.
- a fifth wiring 5505 shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a fourth wiring 5714 .
- first wiring 5501 of the first stage flip-flop 5701 _ 1 shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a first wiring 5711 .
- second wiring 5502 of the n-th stage flip-flop 5701 _n shown in FIG. 25 is connected to a sixth wiring 5716 .
- first wiring 5711 , the second wiring 5712 , the third wiring 5713 , and the sixth wiring 5716 may be referred to as a first signal line, a second signal line, a third signal line, and a fourth signal line, respectively.
- the fourth wiring 5714 and the fifth wiring 5715 may be referred to as a first power supply line and a second power supply line, respectively.
- FIG. 25 shows details of the flip-flop shown in FIG. 24 .
- a flip-flop shown in FIG. 25 includes a first thin film transistor 5571 , a second thin film transistor 5572 , a third thin film transistor 5573 , a fourth thin film transistor 5574 , a fifth thin film transistor 5575 , a sixth thin film transistor 5576 , a seventh thin film transistor 5577 , and an eighth thin film transistor 5578 .
- Each of the first thin film transistor 5571 , the second thin film transistor 5572 , the third thin film transistor 5573 , the fourth thin film transistor 5574 , the fifth thin film transistor 5575 , the sixth thin film transistor 5576 , the seventh thin film transistor 5577 , and the eighth thin film transistor 5578 is an n-channel transistor and is turned on when the gate-source voltage (V gs ) exceeds the threshold voltage (V th ).
- a first electrode (one of a source electrode and a drain electrode) of the first thin film transistor 5571 is connected to the fourth wiring 5504 .
- a second electrode (the other of the source electrode and the drain electrode) of the first thin film transistor 5571 is connected to the third wiring 5503 .
- a first electrode of the second thin film transistor 5572 is connected to the sixth wiring 5506 .
- a second electrode of the second thin film transistor 5572 is connected to the third wiring 5503 .
- a first electrode of the third thin film transistor 5573 is connected to the fifth wiring 5505 , and a second electrode of the third thin film transistor 5573 is connected to a gate electrode of the second thin film transistor 5572 .
- a gate electrode of the third thin film transistor 5573 is connected to the fifth wiring 5505 .
- a first electrode of the fourth thin film transistor 5574 is connected to the sixth wiring 5506 .
- a second electrode of the fourth thin film transistor 5574 is connected to a gate electrode of the second thin film transistor 5572 .
- a gate electrode of the fourth thin film transistor 5574 is connected to a gate electrode of the first thin film transistor 5571 .
- a first electrode of the fifth thin film transistor 5575 is connected to the fifth wiring 5505 .
- a second electrode of the fifth thin film transistor 5575 is connected to the gate electrode of the first thin film transistor 5571 .
- a gate electrode of the fifth thin film transistor 5575 is connected to the first wiring 5501 .
- a first electrode of the sixth thin film transistor 5576 is connected to the sixth wiring 5506 .
- a second electrode of the sixth thin film transistor 5576 is connected to the gate electrode of the first thin film transistor 5571 .
- a gate electrode of the sixth thin film transistor 5576 is connected to the gate electrode of the second thin film transistor 5572 .
- a first electrode of the seventh thin film transistor 5577 is connected to the sixth wiring 5506 .
- a second electrode of the seventh thin film transistor 5577 is connected to the gate electrode of the first thin film transistor 5571 .
- a gate electrode of the seventh thin film transistor 5577 is connected to the second wiring 5502 .
- a first electrode of the eighth thin film transistor 5578 is connected to the sixth wiring 5506 .
- a second electrode of the eighth thin film transistor 5578 is connected to the gate electrode of the second thin film transistor 5572 .
- a gate electrode of the eighth thin film transistor 5578 is connected to the first wiring 5501 .
- the points at which the gate electrode of the first thin film transistor 5571 , the gate electrode of the fourth thin film transistor 5574 , the second electrode of the fifth thin film transistor 5575 , the second electrode of the sixth thin film transistor 5576 , and the second electrode of the seventh thin film transistor 5577 are connected are each referred to as a node 5543 .
- the points at which the gate electrode of the second thin film transistor 5572 , the second electrode of the third thin film transistor 5573 , the second electrode of the fourth thin film transistor 5574 , the gate electrode of the sixth thin film transistor 5576 , and the second electrode of the eighth thin film transistor 5578 are connected are each referred to as a node 5544 .
- first wiring 5501 , the second wiring 5502 , the third wiring 5503 , and the fourth wiring 5504 may be referred to as a first signal line, a second signal line, a third signal line, and a fourth signal line, respectively.
- the fifth wiring 5505 and the sixth wiring 5506 may be referred to as a first power supply line and a second power supply line, respectively.
- the signal line driver circuit and the scan line driver circuit can be manufactured using only the n-channel TFTs described in any of Embodiments 1 to 3.
- the n-channel TFT described in any one of Embodiments 1 to 3 has a high mobility, and thus a driving frequency of a driver circuit can be increased.
- frequency characteristics also referred to as f characteristics
- a scan line driver circuit using the n-channel TFT described in any of Embodiments 1 to 3 can operate at high speed, and thus a frame frequency can be increased and insertion of black images and the like can be realized.
- the channel width of the transistor in the scan line driver circuit is increased or a plurality of scan line driver circuits are provided, for example, higher frame frequency can be realized.
- a scan line driver circuit for driving scan lines of even-numbered rows is provided on one side and a scan line driver circuit for driving scan lines of odd-numbered rows is provided on the opposite side; thus, an increase in frame frequency can be realized.
- the use of the plurality of scan line driver circuits for output of signals to the same scan line is advantageous in increasing the size of a display device.
- FIG. 20B illustrates an example of a block diagram of an active matrix light-emitting display device.
- the display device illustrated in FIG. 20B includes, over a substrate 5400 , a pixel portion 5401 having a plurality of pixels each provided with a display element, a first scan line driver circuit 5402 and a second scan line driver circuit 5404 that select a pixel, and a signal line driver circuit 5403 that controls input of a video signal to the selected pixel.
- grayscale can be displayed using an area grayscale method or a time grayscale method.
- An area grayscale method refers to a driving method in which one pixel is divided into a plurality of subpixels and the respective subpixels are driven independently based on video signals so that grayscale is displayed.
- a time grayscale method refers to a driving method in which a period during which a pixel emits light is controlled so that grayscale is displayed.
- the light-emitting element is more suitable for a time grayscale method than the liquid crystal element.
- one frame period is divided into a plurality of subframe periods.
- the light-emitting element in the pixel is brought into a light-emitting state or a non-light-emitting state in each subframe period.
- a signal which is input to a first scan line serving as a gate wiring of one of the switching TFTs is generated in the first scan line driver circuit 5402 and a signal which is input to a second scan line serving as a gate wiring of the other of the switching TFTs is generated in the second scan line driver circuit 5404 .
- the signal which is input to the first scan line and the signal which is input to the second scan line may be generated together in one scan line driver circuit.
- one scan line driver circuit may generate all signals that are input to the plurality of scan lines, or a plurality of scan line driver circuits may generate signals that are input to the plurality of scan lines.
- a part of a driver circuit that can include n-channel TFTs among driver circuits can be formed over the same substrate as the thin film transistors of the pixel portion.
- the signal line driver circuit and the scan line driver circuit can be manufactured using only the n-channel TFTs described in any of Embodiments 1 to 3.
- the above-described driver circuit can be used for an electronic paper that drives electronic ink using an element electrically connected to a switching element, without being limited to applications to a liquid crystal display device or a light-emitting display device.
- the electronic paper is also referred to as an electrophoretic display device (an electrophoretic display) and is advantageous in that it has the same level of readability as plain paper, it has lower power consumption than other display devices, and it can be made thin and lightweight.
- Electrophoretic displays can have various modes. Electrophoretic displays contain a plurality of microcapsules dispersed in a solvent or a solute, each microcapsule containing first particles which are positively charged and second particles which are negatively charged. By applying an electric field to the microcapsules, the particles in the microcapsules move in opposite directions to each other and only the color of the particles gathering on one side is displayed. Note that the first particles and the second particles each contain pigment and do not move without an electric field. Moreover, the first particles and the second particles have different colors (which may be colorless).
- an electrophoretic display is a display that utilizes a so-called dielectrophoretic effect by which a substance having a high dielectric constant moves to a high-electric field region.
- the electrophoretic display does not require a polarizing plate which is necessary for a liquid crystal display device, so that the weight thereof is reduced.
- a solution in which the above microcapsules are dispersed in a solvent is referred to as electronic ink.
- This electronic ink can be printed on a surface of glass, plastic, cloth, paper, or the like. Furthermore, by using a color filter or particles that have a pigment, color display can also be achieved.
- an active matrix display device can be completed, and display can be performed by application of an electric field to the microcapsules.
- the active matrix substrate obtained using the thin film transistor of any of Embodiments 1 to 3 can be used.
- first particles and the second particles in the microcapsules may each be formed of a single material selected from a conductive material, an insulating material, a semiconductor material, a magnetic material, a liquid crystal material, a ferroelectric material, an electroluminescent material, an electrochromic material, and a magnetophoretic material, or formed of a composite material of any of these.
- a thin film transistor is manufactured, and a semiconductor device having a display function (also referred to as a display device) can be manufactured using the thin film transistor in a pixel portion and further in a driver circuit. Further, part or whole of the driver circuit can be formed over the same substrate as a pixel portion, using a thin film transistor, whereby a system-on-panel can be obtained.
- a display device also referred to as a display device
- the display device includes a display element.
- a liquid crystal element also referred to as a liquid crystal display element
- a light-emitting element also referred to as a light-emitting display element
- the light-emitting element includes, in its category, an element whose luminance is controlled by the current or the voltage, and specifically includes, in its category, an inorganic electroluminescent (EL) element, an organic EL element, and the like.
- EL inorganic electroluminescent
- a display medium whose contrast is changed by an electric effect, such as electronic ink, can be used.
- the display device includes a panel in which the display element is sealed, and a module in which an IC or the like including a controller is mounted on the panel.
- an element substrate which corresponds to one embodiment before the display element is completed in a manufacturing process of the display device, is provided with a means for supplying current to the display element in each of a plurality of pixels.
- the element substrate may be in a state provided with only a pixel electrode of the display element, a state after a conductive film serving as a pixel electrode is formed and before the conductive film is etched to form the pixel electrode, or any of other states.
- a display device in this specification means an image display device, a display device, or a light source (including a lighting device).
- the “display device” includes the following modules in its category: a module including a connector such as a flexible printed circuit (FPC), a tape automated bonding (TAB) tape, or a tape carrier package (TCP) attached; a module having a TAB tape or a TCP which is provided with a printed wiring board at the end thereof; and a module having an integrated circuit (IC) which is directly mounted on a display element by a chip on glass (COG) method.
- FPC flexible printed circuit
- TAB tape automated bonding
- TCP tape carrier package
- COG chip on glass
- FIGS. 16 A 1 and 16 A 2 are each a plan view of a panel in which highly reliable thin film transistors 4010 and 4011 each including the oxide semiconductor layer described in Embodiment 3 and a liquid crystal element 4013 are sealed between a first substrate 4001 and a second substrate 4006 with a sealant 4005 .
- FIG. 16B is a cross-sectional view along line M-N in FIGS. 16 A 1 and 16 A 2 .
- the sealant 4005 is provided so as to surround a pixel portion 4002 and a scan line driver circuit 4004 which are provided over the first substrate 4001 .
- the second substrate 4006 is provided over the pixel portion 4002 and the scan line driver circuit 4004 . Therefore, the pixel portion 4002 and the scan line driver circuit 4004 are sealed together with a liquid crystal layer 4008 , by the first substrate 4001 , the sealant 4005 , and the second substrate 4006 .
- a signal line driver circuit 4003 that is formed using a single crystal semiconductor film or a polycrystalline semiconductor film over a substrate separately prepared is mounted in a region that is different from the region surrounded by the sealant 4005 over the first substrate 4001 .
- connection method of a driver circuit which is separately formed is not particularly limited, and a COG method, a wire bonding method, a TAB method, or the like can be used.
- FIG. 16 A 1 illustrates an example of mounting the signal line driver circuit 4003 by a COG method
- FIG. 16 A 2 illustrates an example of mounting the signal line driver circuit 4003 by a TAB method.
- the pixel portion 4002 and the scan line driver circuit 4004 provided over the first substrate 4001 include a plurality of thin film transistors.
- FIG. 16B illustrates the thin film transistor 4010 included in the pixel portion 4002 and the thin film transistor 4011 included in the scan line driver circuit 4004 .
- insulating layers 4020 and 4021 are provided.
- any of the highly reliable thin film transistors including the oxide semiconductor layer described in Embodiment 3, can be used as the thin film transistors 4010 and 4011 .
- the thin film transistor described in Embodiment 1 or 2 may be applied.
- the thin film transistors 4010 and 4011 are n-channel thin film transistors.
- a pixel electrode layer 4030 included in the liquid crystal element 4013 is electrically connected to the thin film transistor 4010 .
- a counter electrode layer 4031 of the liquid crystal element 4013 is provided for the second substrate 4006 .
- a portion where the pixel electrode layer 4030 , the counter electrode layer 4031 , and the liquid crystal layer 4008 overlap with one another corresponds to the liquid crystal element 4013 .
- the pixel electrode layer 4030 and the counter electrode layer 4031 are provided with an insulating layer 4032 and an insulating layer 4033 respectively which each function as an alignment film, and the liquid crystal layer 4008 is sandwiched between the pixel electrode layer 4030 and the counter electrode layer 4031 with the insulating layers 4032 and 4033 therebetween.
- first substrate 4001 and the second substrate 4006 can be formed of glass, metal (typically, stainless steel), ceramic, or plastic.
- plastic a fiberglass-reinforced plastics (FRP) plate, a polyvinyl fluoride (PVF) film, a polyester film, or an acrylic resin film can be used.
- FRP fiberglass-reinforced plastics
- PVF polyvinyl fluoride
- polyester film a polyester film
- acrylic resin film acrylic resin film
- a sheet with a structure in which an aluminum foil is sandwiched between PVF films or polyester films can be used.
- Reference numeral 4035 denotes a columnar spacer obtained by selectively etching an insulating film and is provided to control the distance between the pixel electrode layer 4030 and the counter electrode layer 4031 (a cell gap). Alternatively, a spherical spacer may also be used.
- the counter electrode layer 4031 is electrically connected to a common potential line formed over the same substrate as the thin film transistor 4010 . With use of the common connection portion, the counter electrode layer 4031 and the common potential line can be electrically connected to each other by conductive particles arranged between a pair of substrates. Note that the conductive particles are included in the sealant 4005 .
- liquid crystal exhibiting a blue phase for which an alignment film is unnecessary may be used.
- a blue phase is one of liquid crystal phases, which is generated just before a cholesteric phase changes into an isotropic phase while temperature of cholesteric liquid crystal is increased. Since the blue phase is generated within an only narrow range of temperature, liquid crystal composition containing a chiral agent at 5 wt % or more so as to improve the temperature range is used for the liquid crystal layer 4008 .
- the liquid crystal composition which includes liquid crystal exhibiting a blue phase and a chiral agent have such characteristics that the response time is 1 msec or less, which is short, the alignment process is unnecessary because the liquid crystal composition has optical isotropy, and viewing angle dependency is small.
- An embodiment of the present invention can also be applied to a reflective liquid crystal display device or a semi-transmissive liquid crystal display device, in addition to a transmissive liquid crystal display device.
- liquid crystal display device in which a polarizing plate is provided on the outer surface of the substrate (on the viewer side) and a coloring layer and an electrode layer used for a display element are provided on the inner surface of the substrate; however, the polarizing plate may be provided on the inner surface of the substrate.
- the stacked structure of the polarizing plate and the coloring layer is not limited to this embodiment and may be set as appropriate depending on materials of the polarizing plate and the coloring layer or conditions of manufacturing process. Further, a light-blocking film serving as a black matrix may be provided.
- the thin film transistor obtained in any of the above embodiments is covered with the insulating layers (the insulating layer 4020 and the insulating layer 4021 ) functioning as a protective film or a planarizing insulating film.
- the protective film is provided to prevent entry of contaminant impurities such as organic substance, metal, or moisture existing in air and is preferably a dense film.
- the protective film may be formed with a single layer or a stacked layer of a silicon oxide film, a silicon nitride film, a silicon oxynitride film, a silicon nitride oxide film, an aluminum oxide film, an aluminum nitride film, an aluminum oxynitride film, and/or an aluminum nitride oxide film by a sputtering method.
- a sputtering method an example in which the protective film is formed by a sputtering method is described in this embodiment, an embodiment of the present invention is not limited to this method and a variety of methods may be employed.
- the insulating layer 4020 having a stacked-layer structure is formed as a protective film.
- a silicon oxide film is formed by a sputtering method.
- the use of a silicon oxide film as a protective film has an effect of preventing hillock of an aluminum film used for the source and drain electrode layers.
- an insulating layer is formed.
- a silicon nitride film is formed by a sputtering method. The use of the silicon nitride film as the protective film can prevent mobile ions such as sodium ions from entering a semiconductor region, thereby suppressing variations in electrical properties of the TFT.
- heat treatment (at 300° C. or lower) may be performed under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere.
- the insulating layer 4021 is formed as the planarizing insulating film.
- an organic material having heat resistance such as polyimide, acrylic, benzocyclobutene, polyamide, or epoxy can be used.
- a low-dielectric constant material a low-k material
- a siloxane-based resin PSG (phosphosilicate glass), BPSG (borophosphosilicate glass), or the like.
- the insulating layer 4021 may be formed by stacking a plurality of insulating films formed of these materials.
- the siloxane-based resin corresponds to a resin including a Si—O—Si bond formed using a siloxane-based material as a starting material.
- the siloxane-based resin may include as a substituent an organic group (e.g., an alkyl group or an aryl group) or a fluoro group.
- the organic group may include a fluoro group.
- a formation method of the insulating layer 4021 is not particularly limited, and the following method can be employed depending on the material: a sputtering method, an SOG method, a spin coating method, a dipping method, a spray coating method, a droplet discharge method (e.g., an ink-jet method, screen printing, offset printing, or the like), or the like.
- the insulating layer 4021 can be formed with a doctor knife, a roll coater, a curtain coater, a knife coater, or the like.
- the baking step of the insulating layer 4021 also serves as annealing of the semiconductor layer, whereby a semiconductor device can be manufactured efficiently.
- the pixel electrode layer 4030 and the counter electrode layer 4031 can be formed using a light-transmitting conductive material such as indium oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium zinc oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide (hereinafter referred to as ITO), indium zinc oxide, indium tin oxide to which silicon oxide is added, or the like.
- a light-transmitting conductive material such as indium oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium zinc oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide (hereinafter referred to as ITO), indium zinc oxide, indium tin oxide to which silicon oxide is added, or the like.
- Conductive compositions including a conductive high molecule can be used for the pixel electrode layer 4030 and the counter electrode layer 4031 .
- the pixel electrode formed using the conductive composition preferably has a sheet resistance of less than or equal to 10000 ohms per square and a transmittance of greater than or equal to 70% at a wavelength of 550 nm. Further, the resistivity of the conductive high molecule included in the conductive composition is preferably less than or equal to 0.1 ⁇ cm.
- a so-called ⁇ -electron conjugated conductive polymer can be used as the conductive high molecule.
- a so-called ⁇ -electron conjugated conductive polymer can be used.
- polyaniline or a derivative thereof, polypyrrole or a derivative thereof, polythiophene or a derivative thereof, a copolymer of two or more kinds of them, and the like can be given.
- the signal line driver circuit 4003 which is formed separately, the scan line driver circuit 4004 , or the pixel portion 4002 from an FPC 4018 .
- a connection terminal electrode 4015 is formed using the same conductive film as the pixel electrode layer 4030 included in the liquid crystal element 4013 .
- a terminal electrode 4016 is formed using the same conductive film as the source and drain electrode layers included in the thin film transistors 4010 and 4011 .
- connection terminal electrode 4015 is electrically connected to a terminal included in the FPC 4018 via an anisotropic conductive film 4019 .
- FIGS. 16 A 1 , 16 A 2 , and 16 B illustrate an example in which the signal line driver circuit 4003 is formed separately and mounted on the first substrate 4001 ; however, the present invention is not limited to this structure.
- the scan line driver circuit may be separately formed and then mounted, or only part of the signal line driver circuit or part of the scan line driver circuit may be separately formed and then mounted.
- FIG. 26 illustrates an example in which a liquid crystal display module is formed as a semiconductor device using a TFT substrate 2600 which is manufactured according to the manufacturing method disclosed in this specification.
- FIG. 26 illustrates an example of a liquid crystal display module, in which the TFT substrate 2600 and a counter substrate 2601 are fixed to each other with a sealant 2602 , and a pixel portion 2603 including TFTs and the like, a display element 2604 including a liquid crystal layer, and a coloring layer 2605 , are provided between the substrates to form a display region.
- the coloring layer 2605 is necessary to perform color display. In the RGB system, respective coloring layers corresponding to colors of red, green, and blue are provided for respective pixels.
- Polarizing plates 2606 and 2607 and a diffusion plate 2613 are provided outside the TFT substrate 2600 and the counter substrate 2601 .
- a light source includes a cold cathode tube 2610 and a reflective plate 2611 , and a circuit board 2612 is connected to a wiring circuit portion 2608 of the TFT substrate 2600 by a flexible wiring board 2609 and includes an external circuit such as a control circuit or a power source circuit.
- the polarizing plate and the liquid crystal layer may be stacked with a retardation plate therebetween.
- the liquid crystal display module can employ a TN (Twisted Nematic) mode, an IPS (In-Plane-Switching) mode, an FFS (Fringe Field Switching) mode, an MVA (Multi-domain Vertical Alignment) mode, a PVA (Patterned Vertical Alignment) mode, an ASM (Axially Symmetric aligned Micro-cell) mode, an OCB (Optical Compensated Birefringence) mode, an FLC (Ferroelectric Liquid Crystal) mode, an AFLC (Anti Ferroelectric Liquid Crystal) mode, or the like.
- TN Transmission Nematic
- IPS In-Plane-Switching
- FFS Fe Field Switching
- MVA Multi-domain Vertical Alignment
- PVA Powerned Vertical Alignment
- ASM Accelerd Vertical Alignment
- OCB Optical Compensated Birefringence
- FLC Fluorroelectric Liquid Crystal
- AFLC Anti Ferro
- An example of an electronic paper will be described as a semiconductor device.
- the semiconductor device can be used for electronic paper in which electronic ink is driven by an element electrically connected to a switching element.
- the electronic paper is also referred to as an electrophoretic display device (an electrophoretic display) and is advantageous in that it has the same level of readability as plain paper, it has lower power consumption than other display devices, and it can be made thin and lightweight.
- Electrophoretic displays can have various modes. Electrophoretic displays contain a plurality of microcapsules dispersed in a solvent or a solute, each microcapsule containing first particles which are positively charged and second particles which are negatively charged. By applying an electric field to the microcapsules, the particles in the microcapsules move in opposite directions to each other and only the color of the particles gathering on one side is displayed. Note that the first particles and the second particles each contain pigment and do not move without an electric field. Moreover, the first particles and the second particles have different colors (which may be colorless).
- an electrophoretic display is a display that utilizes a so-called dielectrophoretic effect by which a substance having a high dielectric constant moves to a high-electric field region.
- a solution in which the above microcapsules are dispersed in a solvent is referred to as electronic ink.
- This electronic ink can be printed on a surface of glass, plastic, cloth, paper, or the like. Furthermore, by using a color filter or particles that have a pigment, color display can also be achieved.
- an active matrix display device can be completed, and display can be performed by application of an electric field to the microcapsules.
- the active matrix substrate obtained using the thin film transistor of any of Embodiments 1 to 3 can be used.
- first particles and the second particles in the microcapsules may each be formed of a single material selected from a conductive material, an insulating material, a semiconductor material, a magnetic material, a liquid crystal material, a ferroelectric material, an electroluminescent material, an electrochromic material, and a magnetophoretic material, or formed of a composite material of any of these.
- FIG. 15 illustrates an active matrix electronic paper as an example of a semiconductor device.
- a thin film transistor 581 used for the semiconductor device can be formed in a manner similar to the thin film transistor described in Embodiment 1, which is a highly reliable thin film transistor including an oxide semiconductor layer. Any of the thin film transistors described in Embodiment 2 or 3 can also be used as the thin film transistor 581 of this embodiment.
- the electronic paper in FIG. 15 is an example of a display device using a twisting ball display system.
- the twisting ball display system refers to a method in which spherical particles each colored in black and white are arranged between a first electrode layer and a second electrode layer which are electrode layers used for a display element, and a potential difference is generated between the first electrode layer and the second electrode layer to control orientation of the spherical particles, so that display is performed.
- the thin film transistor 581 has a bottom-gate structure, which is covered with an insulating film 583 in contact with the semiconductor layer.
- a source electrode layer or a drain electrode layer of the thin film transistor 581 is in contact with a first electrode layer 587 at an opening formed in the insulating film 583 and an insulating layer 585 , whereby the thin film transistor 581 is electrically connected to the first electrode layer 587 .
- spherical particles 589 are provided between the first electrode layer 587 and a second electrode layer 588 .
- Each spherical particle 589 includes a black region 590 a and a white region 590 b, and a cavity 594 filled with liquid around the black region 590 a and the white region 590 b.
- the circumference of the spherical particle 589 is filled with filler 595 such as a resin (see FIG. 15 ).
- the first electrode layer 587 corresponds to a pixel electrode
- the second electrode layer 588 a common electrode.
- the second electrode layer 588 is electrically connected to a common potential line provided over the same substrate 580 as the thin film transistor 581 . With the use of a common connection portion, the second electrode layer 588 can be electrically connected to the common potential line via conductive particles provided between the pair of substrates 580 and 596 .
- an electrophoretic element can also be used.
- the white microparticles and the black microparticles move to opposite sides, so that white or black can be displayed.
- a display element using this principle is an electrophoretic display element and is called electronic paper in general.
- the electrophoretic display element has higher reflectance than a liquid crystal display element, and thus, an auxiliary light is unnecessary, power consumption is low, and a display portion can be recognized in a dim place. In addition, even when power is not supplied to the display portion, an image which has been displayed once can be maintained. Accordingly, a displayed image can be stored even if a semiconductor device having a display function (which may be referred to simply as a display device or a semiconductor device provided with a display device) is distanced from an electric wave source.
- a semiconductor device having a display function which may be referred to simply as a display device or a semiconductor device provided with a display device
- a light-emitting display device As a display element included in a display device, a light-emitting element utilizing electroluminescence is described here. Light-emitting elements utilizing electroluminescence are classified according to whether a light-emitting material is an organic compound or an inorganic compound. In general, the former is referred to as an organic EL element, and the latter is referred to as an inorganic EL element.
- an organic EL element by application of voltage to a light-emitting element, electrons and holes are separately injected from a pair of electrodes into a layer containing a light-emitting organic compound, and current flows.
- the carriers (electrons and holes) are recombined, and thus, the light-emitting organic compound is excited.
- the light-emitting organic compound returns to a ground state from the excited state, thereby emitting light. Owing to such a mechanism, this light-emitting element is referred to as a current-excitation light-emitting element.
- the inorganic EL elements are classified according to their element structures into a dispersion-type inorganic EL element and a thin-film inorganic EL element.
- a dispersion-type inorganic EL element has a light-emitting layer where particles of a light-emitting material are dispersed in a binder, and its light emission mechanism is donor-acceptor recombination type light emission that utilizes a donor level and an acceptor level.
- a thin-film inorganic EL element has a structure where a light-emitting layer is sandwiched between dielectric layers, which are further sandwiched between electrodes, and its light emission mechanism is localized type light emission that utilizes inner-shell electron transition of metal ions. Note that an example of an organic EL element as a light-emitting element is described here.
- FIG. 18 illustrates an example of a pixel structure to which digital time grayscale driving can be applied, as an example of a semiconductor device.
- one pixel includes two n-channel transistors each of which includes an oxide semiconductor layer as a channel formation region.
- a pixel 6400 includes a switching transistor 6401 , a driver transistor 6402 , a light-emitting element 6404 , and a capacitor 6403 .
- a gate of the switching transistor 6401 is connected to a scan line 6406
- a first electrode (one of a source electrode and a drain electrode) of the switching transistor 6401 is connected to a signal line 6405
- a second electrode (the other of the source electrode and the drain electrode) of the switching transistor 6401 is connected to a gate of the driver transistor 6402 .
- the gate of the driver transistor 6402 is connected to a power supply line 6407 via the capacitor 6403 , a first electrode of the driver transistor 6402 is connected to the power supply line 6407 , and a second electrode of the driver transistor 6402 is connected to a first electrode (pixel electrode) of the light-emitting element 6404 .
- a second electrode of the light-emitting element 6404 corresponds to a common electrode 6408 .
- the common electrode 6408 is electrically connected to a common potential line provided over the same substrate.
- the second electrode (common electrode 6408 ) of the light-emitting element 6404 is set to a low power supply potential.
- the low power supply potential is a potential satisfying that the low power supply potential is lower than a high power supply potential (low power supply potential ⁇ high power supply potential) based on the high power supply potential that is set to the power supply line 6407 .
- the low power supply potential GND, 0 V, or the like may be employed, for example.
- a potential difference between the high power supply potential and the low power supply potential is applied to the light-emitting element 6404 and current is supplied to the light-emitting element 6404 , so that the light-emitting element 6404 emits light.
- each potential is set so that the potential difference between the high power supply potential and the low power supply potential is a forward threshold voltage or higher of the light-emitting element 6404 .
- the gate capacitor of the driver transistor 6402 may be used as a substitute for the capacitor 6403 , so that the capacitor 6403 can be omitted.
- the gate capacitance of the driver transistor 6402 may be formed between the channel region and the gate electrode.
- a video signal is input to the gate of the driver transistor 6402 so that the driver transistor 6402 is in either of two states of being sufficiently turned on or turned off. That is, the driver transistor 6402 operates in a linear region. Since the driver transistor 6402 operates in the linear region, a voltage higher than the voltage of the power supply line 6407 is applied to the gate of the driver transistor 6402 . Note that a voltage higher than or equal to the sum voltage of the power supply line voltage and V th of the driver transistor 6402 (voltage of the power supply line+V th of the driver transistor 6402 ) is applied to the signal line 6405 .
- the same pixel structure as that in FIG. 18 can be used by changing signal input.
- a voltage higher than or equal to the sum voltage of the light-emitting element 6404 and V th of the driver transistor 6402 (forward voltage of the light-emitting element 6404 +V th of the driver transistor 6402 ) is applied to the gate of the driver transistor 6402 .
- the forward voltage of the light-emitting element 6404 indicates a voltage at which a desired luminance is obtained, and includes at least forward threshold voltage.
- the video signal by which the driver transistor 6402 operates in a saturation region is input, so that current can be supplied to the light-emitting element 6404 .
- the potential of the power supply line 6407 is set higher than the gate potential of the driver transistor 6402 .
- the pixel structure illustrated in FIG. 18 is not limited thereto.
- a switch, a resistor, a capacitor, a transistor, a logic circuit, or the like may be added to the pixel illustrated in FIG. 18 .
- Driving TFTs 7001 , 7011 , and 7021 used in semiconductor devices illustrated in FIGS. 19A, 19B, and 19C respectively can be formed in a manner similar to the thin film transistor described in Embodiment 1 and are highly reliable thin film transistors each including an oxide semiconductor layer.
- the thin film transistor described in Embodiment 2 or 3 can be employed as the driving TFTs 7001 , 7011 , and 7021 .
- a thin film transistor and a light-emitting element are formed over a substrate.
- a light-emitting element can have a top emission structure, in which light emission is extracted through the surface opposite to the substrate; a bottom emission structure, in which light emission is extracted through the surface on the substrate side; or a dual emission structure, in which light emission is extracted through the surface opposite to the substrate and the surface on the substrate side.
- the pixel structure can be applied to a light-emitting element having any of these emission structures.
- a light-emitting element having a top emission structure will be described with reference to FIG. 19A .
- FIG. 19A is a cross-sectional view of a pixel in the case where the driving TFT 7001 is an n-channel TFT and light is emitted from a light-emitting element 7002 to an anode 7005 side.
- a cathode 7003 of the light-emitting element 7002 is electrically connected to the driving TFT 7001 , and a light-emitting layer 7004 and the anode 7005 are stacked in this order over the cathode 7003 .
- the cathode 7003 can be formed using a variety of conductive materials as long as they have a low work function and reflect light. For example, Ca, Al, MgAg, AlLi, or the like is desirably used.
- the light-emitting layer 7004 may be formed using a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked. When the light-emitting layer 7004 is formed using a plurality of layers, the light-emitting layer 7004 is formed by stacking an electron-injection layer, an electron-transport layer, a light-emitting layer, a hole-transport layer, and a hole-inject layer in this order over the cathode 7003 . It is not necessary to form all of these layers.
- the anode 7005 is formed using a light-transmitting conductive film such as a film of indium oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium zinc oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide (hereinafter referred to as ITO), indium zinc oxide, or indium tin oxide to which silicon oxide is added.
- a light-transmitting conductive film such as a film of indium oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium zinc oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide (hereinafter referred to as ITO), indium zinc oxide, or indium tin oxide to which silicon oxide is added.
- the light-emitting element 7002 corresponds to a region where the light-emitting layer 7004 is sandwiched between the cathode 7003 and the anode 7005 .
- the light-emitting element 7002 corresponds to a region where the light-emitting layer 7004 is sandwiched between the cathode 7003 and the anode 7005 .
- light is emitted from the light-emitting element 7002 to the anode 7005 side as indicated by an arrow.
- FIG. 19B is a cross-sectional view of a pixel in the case where the driving TFT 7011 is of an n-type and light is emitted from a light-emitting element 7012 to a cathode 7013 side.
- the cathode 7013 of the light-emitting element 7012 is formed over a light-transmitting conductive film 7017 that is electrically connected to the driving TFT 7011 , and a light-emitting layer 7014 and an anode 7015 are stacked in this order over the cathode 7013 .
- a light-blocking film 7016 for reflecting or blocking light may be formed to cover the anode 7015 when the anode 7015 has a light-transmitting property.
- the cathode 7013 a variety of materials can be used as in the case of FIG. 19A as long as they are conductive materials having a low work function.
- the cathode 7013 is formed to have a thickness that can transmit light (preferably, approximately 5 nm to 30 nm).
- an aluminum film with a thickness of 20 nm can be used as the cathode 7013 .
- the light-emitting layer 7014 may be formed using either a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked.
- the anode 7015 does not need to transmit light, but can be formed using a light-transmitting conductive material as in the case of FIG. 19A .
- a metal or the like that reflects light can be used for example; however, it is not limited to a metal film.
- a resin or the like to which black pigments are added can also be used.
- the light-emitting element 7012 corresponds to a region where the light-emitting layer 7014 is sandwiched between the cathode 7013 and the anode 7015 .
- the light-emitting element 7012 corresponds to a region where the light-emitting layer 7014 is sandwiched between the cathode 7013 and the anode 7015 .
- light is emitted from the light-emitting element 7012 to the cathode 7013 side as indicated by an arrow.
- a cathode 7023 of a light-emitting element 7022 is formed over a light-transmitting conductive film 7027 which is electrically connected to the driving TFT 7021 , and a light-emitting layer 7024 and an anode 7025 are stacked in this order over the cathode 7023 .
- the cathode 7023 can be formed using a variety of conductive materials as long as they have a low work function.
- the cathode 7023 is formed to have a thickness which allows light transmission.
- a 20-nm-thich aluminum film can be used as the cathode 7023 .
- the light-emitting layer 7024 may be formed using either a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked.
- the anode 7025 can be formed using a light-transmitting conductive material as in the case of FIG. 19A .
- the light-emitting element 7022 corresponds to a region where the cathode 7023 , the light-emitting layer 7024 , and the anode 7025 overlap with one another. In the case of the pixel illustrated in FIG. 19C , light is emitted from the light-emitting element 7022 to both the anode 7025 side and the cathode 7023 side as indicated by arrows.
- organic EL elements are described here as the light-emitting elements, an inorganic EL element can also be provided as a light-emitting element.
- a thin film transistor which controls the driving of a light-emitting element is electrically connected to the light-emitting element; however, a structure may be employed in which a TFT for current control is connected between the driving TFT and the light-emitting element.
- the structure of the semiconductor device is not limited to those illustrated in FIGS. 19A to 19C and can be modified in various ways based on techniques disclosed in this specification.
- FIG. 17A is a plan view of a panel in which a thin film transistor and a light-emitting element formed over a first substrate are sealed between the first substrate and a second substrate with a sealant.
- FIG. 17B is a cross-sectional view along line H-I of FIG. 17A .
- a sealant 4505 is provided so as to surround a pixel portion 4502 , signal line driver circuits 4503 a and 4503 b, and scan line driver circuits 4504 a and 4504 b which are provided over a first substrate 4501 .
- a second substrate 4506 is provided over the pixel portion 4502 , the signal line driver circuits 4503 a and 4503 b, and the scan line driver circuits 4504 a and 4504 b.
- the pixel portion 4502 , the signal line driver circuits 4503 a and 4503 b, and the scan line driver circuits 4504 a and 4504 b are sealed together with a filler 4507 , by the first substrate 4501 , the sealant 4505 , and the second substrate 4506 .
- a panel be packaged (sealed) with a protective film (such as a laminate film or an ultraviolet curable resin film) or a cover material with high air-tightness and little degasification so that the panel is not exposed to the outside air, in this manner.
- the pixel portion 4502 , the signal line driver circuits 4503 a and 4503 b, and the scan line driver circuits 4504 a and 4504 b formed over the first substrate 4501 each include a plurality of thin film transistors, and a thin film transistor 4510 included in the pixel portion 4502 and a thin film transistor 4509 included in the signal line driver circuit 4503 a are illustrated as an example in FIG. 17B .
- the highly reliable thin film transistor including an oxide semiconductor layer described in Embodiment 3 can be employed.
- the thin film transistor described in Embodiment 1 or 2 may be applied.
- the thin film transistors 4509 and 4510 are n-channel thin film transistors.
- reference numeral 4511 denotes a light-emitting element.
- a first electrode layer 4517 which is a pixel electrode included in the light-emitting element 4511 is electrically connected to a source electrode layer or a drain electrode layer of the thin film transistor 4510 .
- the structure of the light-emitting element 4511 is, but not limited to, the stack structure which includes the first electrode layer 4517 , an electroluminescent layer 4512 , and the second electrode layer 4513 .
- the structure of the light-emitting element 4511 can be changed as appropriate depending on the direction in which light is extracted from the light-emitting element 4511 , or the like.
- a partition 4520 is formed using an organic resin film, an inorganic insulating film, or organic polysiloxane. It is particularly preferable that the partition 4520 be formed using a photosensitive material and an opening be formed over the first electrode layer 4517 so that a sidewall of the opening is formed as an inclined surface with continuous curvature.
- the electroluminescent layer 4512 may be formed with a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked.
- a protective film may be formed over the second electrode layer 4513 and the partition 4520 in order to prevent entry of oxygen, hydrogen, moisture, carbon dioxide, or the like into the light-emitting element 4511 .
- a silicon nitride film, a silicon nitride oxide film, a DLC film, or the like can be formed.
- a connection terminal electrode 4515 is formed from the same conductive film as the first electrode layer 4517 included in the light-emitting element 4511 , and a terminal electrode 4516 is formed from the same conductive film as the source and drain electrode layers included in the thin film transistors 4509 and 4510 .
- connection terminal electrode 4515 is electrically connected to a terminal included in the FPC 4518 a via an anisotropic conductive film 4519 .
- the second substrate 4506 located in the direction in which light is extracted from the light-emitting element 4511 needs to have a light-transmitting property.
- a light-transmitting material such as a glass plate, a plastic plate, a polyester film, or an acrylic film is used for the second substrate 4506 .
- an ultraviolet curable resin or a thermosetting resin can be used, in addition to an inert gas such as nitrogen or argon.
- an inert gas such as nitrogen or argon.
- PVC polyvinyl chloride
- acrylic polyimide
- epoxy resin polyimide
- silicone resin polyimide
- EVA ethylene vinyl acetate
- nitrogen is used for the filler.
- an optical film such as a polarizing plate, a circularly polarizing plate (including an elliptically polarizing plate), a retardation plate (a quarter-wave plate or a half-wave plate), or a color filter, may be provided as appropriate on a light-emitting surface of the light-emitting element.
- the polarizing plate or the circularly polarizing plate may be provided with an anti-reflection film. For example, anti-glare treatment by which reflected light can be diffused by projections and depressions on the surface so as to reduce the glare can be performed.
- the signal line driver circuits 4503 a and 4503 b and the scan line driver circuits 4504 a and 4504 b may be mounted with driver circuits formed using a single crystal semiconductor film or a polycrystalline semiconductor film over a substrate separately prepared. Alternatively, only the signal line driver circuits or part thereof, or only the scan line driver circuits or part thereof may be separately formed and mounted. This embodiment is not limited to the structure illustrated in FIGS. 17A and 17B .
- a semiconductor device disclosed in this specification can be applied to an electronic paper.
- An electronic paper can be used for electronic appliances of a variety of fields as long as they can display data.
- an electronic paper can be applied to an e-book reader (electronic book), a poster, an advertisement in a vehicle such as a train, or displays of various cards such as a credit card. Examples of such electronic appliances are illustrated in FIG. 27 .
- FIG. 27 illustrates an example of an e-book reader 2700 .
- the e-book reader 2700 includes two housings, a housing 2701 and a housing 2703 .
- the housing 2701 and the housing 2703 are combined with a hinge 2711 so that the e-book reader 2700 can be opened and closed with the hinge 2711 as an axis.
- the e-book reader 2700 can operate like a paper book.
- a display portion 2705 and a display portion 2707 are incorporated in the housing 2701 and the housing 2703 , respectively.
- the display portion 2705 and the display portion 2707 may display one image or different images.
- a display portion on the right side can display text
- a display portion on the left side can display graphics.
- FIG. 27 illustrates an example in which the housing 2701 is provided with an operation portion and the like.
- the housing 2701 is provided with a power switch 2721 , an operation key 2723 , a speaker 2725 , and the like.
- the operation key 2723 pages can be turned.
- a keyboard, a pointing device, or the like may also be provided on the surface of the housing, on which the display portion is provided.
- an external connection terminal (an earphone terminal, a USB terminal, a terminal that can be connected to various cables such as an AC adapter and a USB cable, or the like), a recording medium insertion portion, and the like may be provided on the back surface or the side surface of the housing.
- the e-book reader 2700 may have a function of an electronic dictionary.
- the e-book reader 2700 may have a configuration capable of wirelessly transmitting and receiving data. Through wireless communication, desired book data or the like can be purchased and downloaded from an electronic book server.
- a semiconductor device disclosed in this specification can be applied to a variety of electronic appliances (including game machines).
- electronic appliances are a television set (also referred to as a television or a television receiver), a monitor of a computer or the like, a camera such as a digital camera or a digital video camera, a digital photo frame, a mobile phone handset (also referred to as a mobile phone or a mobile phone device), a portable game console, a portable information terminal, an audio reproducing device, a large-sized game machine such as a pachinko machine, and the like.
- FIG. 28A illustrates an example of a television set 9600 .
- a display portion 9603 is incorporated in a housing 9601 .
- the display portion 9603 can display images.
- the housing 9601 is supported by a stand 9605 .
- the television set 9600 can be operated with an operation switch of the housing 9601 or a separate remote controller 9610 .
- Channels and volume can be controlled with an operation key 9609 of the remote controller 9610 so that an image displayed on the display portion 9603 can be controlled.
- the remote controller 9610 may be provided with a display portion 9607 for displaying data output from the remote controller 9610 .
- the television set 9600 is provided with a receiver, a modem, and the like. With the use of the receiver, general television broadcasting can be received. Moreover, when the display device is connected to a communication network with or without wires via the modem, one-way (from a sender to a receiver) or two-way (between a sender and a receiver or between receivers) information communication can be performed.
- FIG. 28B illustrates an example of a digital photo frame 9700 .
- a display portion 9703 is incorporated in a housing 9701 .
- the display portion 9703 can display a variety of images.
- the display portion 9703 can display data of an image taken with a digital camera or the like and function as a normal photo frame.
- the digital photo frame 9700 is provided with an operation portion, an external connection terminal (a USB terminal, a terminal that can be connected to various cables such as a USB cable, or the like), a recording medium insertion portion, and the like.
- an external connection terminal a USB terminal, a terminal that can be connected to various cables such as a USB cable, or the like
- a recording medium insertion portion a recording medium insertion portion, and the like.
- these components may be provided on the surface on which the display portion is provided, it is preferable to provide them on the side surface or the back surface for the design of the digital photo frame 9700 .
- a memory storing data of an image taken with a digital camera is inserted in the recording medium insertion portion of the digital photo frame, whereby the image data can be transferred and then displayed on the display portion 9703 .
- the digital photo frame 9700 may be configured to transmit and receive data wirelessly.
- the structure may be employed in which desired image data is transferred wirelessly to be displayed.
- FIG. 29A is a portable game machine and includes two housings, a housing 9881 and a housing 9891 , which are connected with a joint portion 9893 so that the portable game machine can be opened or folded.
- a display portion 9882 and a display portion 9883 are incorporated in the housing 9881 and the housing 9891 , respectively.
- 29A includes a speaker portion 9884 , a recording medium insertion portion 9886 , an LED lamp 9890 , an input means (an operation key 9885 , a connection terminal 9887 , a sensor 9888 (a sensor having a function of measuring force, displacement, position, speed, acceleration, angular velocity, rotational frequency, distance, light, liquid, magnetism, temperature, chemical substance, sound, time, hardness, electric field, current, voltage, electric power, radiation, flow rate, humidity, gradient, oscillation, odor, or infrared rays), or a microphone 9889 ), and the like.
- an operation key 9885 a sensor 9888 (a sensor having a function of measuring force, displacement, position, speed, acceleration, angular velocity, rotational frequency, distance, light, liquid, magnetism, temperature, chemical substance, sound, time, hardness, electric field, current, voltage, electric power, radiation, flow rate, humidity, gradient, oscillation, odor, or infrared rays), or
- the structure of the portable game machine is not limited to the above and other structures provided with at least a semiconductor device disclosed in this specification can be employed.
- the portable game machine may include other accessory equipment as appropriate.
- the portable game machine illustrated in FIG. 29A has a function of reading a program or data stored in a recording medium to display it on the display portion, and a function of sharing information with another portable game machine via wireless communication. Note that a function of the portable game machine illustrated in FIG. 29A is not limited to those described above, and the portable game machine can have a variety of functions.
- FIG. 29B illustrates an example of a slot machine 9900 which is a large-sized game machine.
- a display portion 9903 is incorporated in a housing 9901 .
- the slot machine 9900 includes an operation means such as a start lever or a stop switch, a coin slot, a speaker, and the like. It is needless to say that the structure of the slot machine 9900 is not limited to the above and other structures provided with at least a semiconductor device disclosed in this specification may be employed.
- the slot machine 9900 may include other accessory equipment as appropriate.
- FIG. 30A is a perspective view illustrating an example of a portable computer.
- a top housing 9301 having a display portion 9303 and a bottom housing 9302 having a keyboard 9304 can overlap with each other by closing a hinge unit which connects the top housing 9301 and the bottom housing 9302 .
- the portable computer of FIG. 30A can be convenient for carrying, and in the case of using the keyboard for input, the hinge unit is opened and the user can input data looking at the display portion 9303 .
- the bottom housing 9302 includes a pointing device 9306 with which input can be performed, in addition to the keyboard 9304 . Further, when the display portion 9303 is a touch input panel, input can be performed by touching part of the display portion.
- the bottom housing 9302 includes an arithmetic function portion such as a CPU or hard disk.
- the bottom housing 9302 includes another device, for example, an external connection port 9305 into which a communication cable conformable to communication standards of a USB is inserted.
- the top housing 9301 which includes a display portion 9307 and can keep the display portion 9307 therein by sliding it toward the inside of the top housing 9301 , can have a large display screen.
- the user can adjust the orientation of a screen of the display portion 9307 which can be kept in the top housing 9301 .
- the display portion 9307 which can be kept in the top housing 9301 is a touch input panel, input can be performed by touching part of the display portion 9307 which can be kept in the top housing 9301 .
- the display portion 9303 or the display portion 9307 which can be kept in the top housing 9301 are formed using an image display device of a liquid crystal display panel, a light-emitting display panel such as an organic light-emitting element or an inorganic light-emitting element, or the like.
- the portable computer in FIG. 30A can be provided with a receiver and the like and can receive a television broadcast to display an image on the display portion.
- the user can watch a television broadcast when the whole screen of the display portion 9307 is exposed by sliding the display portion 9307 while the hinge unit which connects the top housing 9301 and the bottom housing 9302 is kept closed. In this case, the hinge unit is not opened and display is not performed on the display portion 9303 .
- start up of only a circuit for displaying a television broadcast is performed. Therefore, power can be consumed to the minimum, which is useful for the portable computer whose battery capacity is limited.
- FIG. 30B is a perspective view illustrating an example of a mobile phone that the user can wear on the wrist like a wristwatch.
- This mobile phone is formed with a main body which includes a communication device including at least a telephone function, and battery; a band portion which enables the main body to be worn on the wrist; an adjusting portion 9205 for adjusting the fixation of the band portion fixed for the wrist; a display portion 9201 ; a speaker 9207 ; and a microphone 9208 .
- the main body includes operation switches 9203 .
- the operation switches 9203 can serve, for example, as a switch for starting a program for the Internet when the switch is pushed, in addition to serving as a switch for turning on a power source, a switch for shifting the display, a switch for instruction to start taking images, or the like, and can be configured to have respective functions.
- Input to this mobile phone is operated by touching the display portion 9201 with a finger or an input pen, operating the operation switches 9203 , or inputting voice into the microphone 9208 .
- displayed buttons 9202 which are displayed on the display portion 9201 are illustrated in FIG. 30B . Input can be performed by touching the displayed buttons 9202 with a finger or the like.
- the main body includes a camera portion 9206 including an image pick-up means having a function of converting an image of an object, which is formed through a camera lens, to an electronic image signal.
- the camera portion is not necessarily provided.
- the mobile phone illustrated in FIG. 30B is provided with a receiver of a television broadcast and the like, and can display an image on the display portion 9201 by receiving a television broadcast.
- the mobile phone illustrated in FIG. 30B is provided with a memory device and the like such as a memory, and can record a television broadcast in the memory.
- the mobile phone illustrated in FIG. 30B may have a function of collecting location information, such as the GPS.
- An image display device of a liquid crystal display panel, a light-emitting display panel such as an organic light-emitting element or an inorganic light-emitting element, or the like is used as the display portion 9201 .
- the cellular phone illustrated in FIG. 30B is compact and lightweight and the battery capacity of the cellular phone illustrated in FIG. 30B is limited. Therefore, a panel which can be driven with low power consumption is preferably used as a display device for the display portion 9201 .
- FIG. 30B illustrates the electronic appliances which are worn on the wrist; however, this embodiment is not limited thereto as long as a portable shape is employed.
- FIGS. 31A to 31D An example in which heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed after formation of source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b is illustrated in FIGS. 31A to 31D . Note that portions the same as those in FIGS. 6A to 6D are denoted by the same reference numerals.
- the gate electrode layer 401 is formed over the substrate 400 having an insulating surface (see FIG. 31A ).
- the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b are formed over the oxide semiconductor layer 430 , and the oxide semiconductor layer 430 is partly etched, so that an oxide semiconductor layer 441 is formed (see FIG. 31B ).
- the oxide semiconductor layer 441 and the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b are subjected to heat treatment and slow cooling under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure.
- This heat treatment causes dehydration or dehydrogenation in the oxide semiconductor layer 441 , so that resistance of the oxide semiconductor layer 441 is reduced.
- the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 432 can be obtained (see FIG. 31C ).
- a material which has heat resistance enough to withstand heat treatment such as tungsten or molybdenum, is preferably used as the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b.
- the oxide insulating film 407 is formed to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer 432 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method without exposure to air.
- the oxide insulating film 407 is formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 432 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method, in the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 432 , at least a region in contact with the oxide insulating film 407 has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 , more preferably 1 ⁇ 10 14 /cm 3 or lower), so that a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 432 becomes the semiconductor layer 403 having a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region (a third oxide semiconductor layer), and then the thin film transistor 470 can be completed (see FIG. 31D ).
- Impurities (such as H 2 O, H, and OH) contained in the oxide semiconductor layer are reduced by performance of the heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, and the carrier concentration is increased. After that, slow cooling is performed. Then, formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer, or the like, is performed, so that the carrier concentration is reduced. Thus, reliability of the thin film transistor 470 can be improved.
- a semiconductor device and a method of manufacturing the semiconductor device will be described with reference to FIG. 32 .
- the same portion as or a portion having similar function to those described in Embodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described in Embodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted.
- the thin film transistor 471 illustrated in FIG. 32 is an example, in which a conductive layer 409 is provided to overlap with the gate electrode layer 401 and a channel region of the semiconductor layer 403 with an insulating film interposed therebetween.
- FIG. 32 is a cross-sectional view of the thin film transistor 471 included in a semiconductor device.
- the thin film transistor 471 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over the substrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, the gate electrode layer 401 , the gate insulating layer 402 , the semiconductor layer 403 , the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b, and the conductive layer 409 .
- the conductive layer 409 is provided over the oxide insulating film 407 so as to overlap with the gate electrode layer 401 .
- the conductive layer 409 can be formed using a material similar to that of the gate electrode layer 401 or the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b by a method similar thereto. In the case of providing a pixel electrode layer, the conductive layer 409 may be formed using a material similar to that of the pixel electrode by a method similar thereto. In this embodiment, the conductive layer 409 is formed using a stacked layer of a titanium film, an aluminum film, and a titanium film.
- the conductive layer 409 may have the same potential as the gate electrode layer 401 or have potential different from that of the gate electrode layer 401 and can function as a second gate electrode layer. Further, the conductive layer 409 may be in a floating state.
- the conductive layer 409 in a position overlapping with the semiconductor layer 403 , in a bias-temperature stress test (BT test) for examining reliability of a thin film transistor, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of the thin film transistor 471 between before and after the BT test can be reduced.
- BT test bias-temperature stress test
- shift in threshold voltage can be suppressed.
- Embodiment 1 can be freely combined with Embodiment 1.
- a semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to FIG. 33 .
- the same portion as or a portion having similar function to those described in Embodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described in Embodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted.
- a thin film transistor 472 illustrated in FIG. 33 is an example, in which a conductive layer 419 is provided to overlap with the gate electrode layer 401 and a channel region of the semiconductor layer 403 with the oxide insulating film 407 and an insulating layer 410 interposed therebetween.
- FIG. 33 is a cross-sectional view of the thin film transistor 472 included in a semiconductor device.
- the thin film transistor 472 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over the substrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, the gate electrode layer 401 , the gate insulating layer 402 , the semiconductor layer 403 , source and drain regions 404 a and 404 b, the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b, and the conductive layer 419 .
- the conductive layer 419 is provided over the oxide insulating film 407 and the insulating layer 410 to overlap with the gate electrode layer 401 .
- the insulating layer 410 serving as a planarization film is stacked over the oxide insulating film 407 , and an opening which reaches the source or drain electrode layer 405 b is formed in the oxide insulating film 407 and the insulating layer 410 .
- a conductive film is formed over the insulating layer 410 and in the opening formed in the oxide insulating film 407 and the insulating layer 410 , and etched into a desired shape, so that the conductive layer 419 and a pixel electrode layer 411 are formed.
- the conductive layer 419 can be formed together with the pixel electrode layer 411 , using the same material by the same method.
- the pixel electrode layer 411 and the conductive layer 419 are formed using indium oxide-tin oxide alloy containing silicon oxide (an In—Sn—O based oxide containing silicon oxide).
- the conductive layer 419 may be formed using a material similar to that of the gate electrode layer 401 or the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b by a method similar thereto.
- the conductive layer 419 may have the same potential as the gate electrode layer 401 or have potential different from that of the gate electrode layer 401 and can function as a second gate electrode layer. Further, the conductive layer 419 may be in a floating state.
- the amount of shift in threshold voltage of the thin film transistor 472 between before and after the BT test can be reduced.
- Embodiment 1 can be freely combined with Embodiment 1.
- FIG. 34C illustrates an example of a top view of the thin film transistor, cross-sectional view along dotted line Z 1 -Z 2 of which corresponds to FIG. 34B . Described in this embodiment is an example in which gallium is not contained in an oxide semiconductor layer of the thin film transistor 1430 .
- a gate electrode layer 1401 is formed over a substrate 1400 .
- an oxide semiconductor layer is formed over a gate insulating layer 1402 covering the gate electrode layer 1401 .
- the oxide semiconductor layer is formed using a Sn-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor by a sputtering method.
- gallium is not used for the oxide semiconductor layer, cost can be reduced because an expensive target is not used in formation of the oxide semiconductor layer.
- dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed.
- heat treatment is performed under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure, and then, slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere.
- the heat treatment is performed at 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive.
- the oxide semiconductor layer can have reduced resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 or higher), so that a low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 1403 can be provided (see FIG. 34A ).
- a channel protective layer 1418 is provided to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 .
- the channel protective layer 1418 can prevent the channel formation region of the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 to be damaged in the manufacturing process (e.g., reduction in thickness due to plasma or an etchant in etching). Accordingly, reliability of the thin film transistor 1430 can be improved.
- the channel protective layer 1418 can be formed successively without exposure to air. Successive film formation without being exposed to air makes it possible to obtain each interface of stacked layers, which are not contaminated by atmospheric components or impurity elements floating in air. Therefore, variation in characteristics of the thin film transistor can be reduced.
- the channel protective layer 1418 that is an oxide insulating film is formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 1403 , by a sputtering method, a PCVD method, or the like, in the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 1403 , at least a region which is in contact with the channel protective layer 1418 can have increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 , more preferably 1 ⁇ 10 14 /cm 3 or lower).
- the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 , more preferably 1 ⁇ 10 14 /cm 3 or lower.
- a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained.
- it is important to increase and decrease the carrier concentration in the oxide semiconductor layer through performance of heat treatment and slow cooling under an inert-gas atmosphere (or reduced pressure), formation of an oxide insulating film, and the like.
- the channel protective layer 1418 can be formed using an inorganic material including oxygen (such as silicon oxide, silicon oxynitride, or silicon nitride oxide).
- oxygen such as silicon oxide, silicon oxynitride, or silicon nitride oxide.
- a vapor deposition method such as a plasma CVD method or a thermal CVD method or a sputtering method can be used.
- the channel protective layer 1418 is processed by etching a shape of a deposited film.
- the channel protective layer 1418 is formed in such a manner that a silicon oxide film is formed by a sputtering method and processed by etching using a mask formed by photolithography.
- n + layers 1406 a and 1406 b are formed over the channel protective layer 1418 and the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 .
- the n + layers 1406 a and 1406 b serving as source and drain regions which are oxide semiconductor layers having lower resistance, are formed of an Al-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film under deposition conditions different from the deposition conditions of the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 .
- the n + layers 1406 a and 1406 b may be formed using an Al-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film containing nitrogen, that is, an Al-Zn-O-N-based non-single-crystal film (also called an AZON film).
- a source electrode layer 1405 a and a drain electrode layer 1405 b are formed over the n
- the source and drain electrode layers 1405 a and 1405 b are formed using any of an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, Mo, and W, an alloy including any of the elements as a component, an alloy film including a combination of any of the elements, and the like.
- the source and drain electrode layers 1405 a and 1405 b may have a stacked layer including any of the above.
- Provision of the n + layers 1406 a and 1406 b can make a good junction between the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 and the source and drain electrode layers 1405 a and 1405 which are metal layers, which allows higher thermal stability than in the case of providing Schottky junction.
- willing provision of the n + layer is effective in supplying carriers to the channel (on the source side), stably absorbing carriers from the channel (on the drain side), or preventing a resistance component from being formed at an interface between the wiring and the oxide semiconductor layer.
- resistance is reduced, good mobility can be ensured even with a high drain voltage.
- this embodiment is not limited to the above-described structure including the n + layers 1406 a and 1406 b; a structure in which an n + layer is not provided may be employed.
- the thin film transistor 1430 is subjected to heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air) (at a temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C.).
- heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for one hour.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 in a condition of being in contact with the channel protective layer 1418 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of the thin film transistor 1470 can be reduced.
- this heat treatment at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably
- this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing.
- FIGS. 35A and 35B A semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to FIGS. 35A and 35B .
- the same portion or a portion having a function similar to that of Embodiment 13 and the same steps as those of Embodiment 13 can be made as described in Embodiment 13; thus the repetitive description thereof is omitted.
- a thin film transistor 1431 illustrated in FIG. 35A is an example having a structure in which a conductive layer 1409 is provided to overlap with the gate electrode layer 1401 and a channel region of the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 with the channel protective layer 1418 and an insulating layer 1407 interposed therebetween.
- FIG. 35A is a cross-sectional view of the thin film transistor 1431 included in a semiconductor device.
- the thin film transistor 1431 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor, which includes, over the substrate 1400 having an insulating surface, the gate electrode layer 1401 , the gate insulating layer 1402 , the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 , the source and drain regions 1404 a and 1404 b, the source and drain electrode layers 1405 a and 1405 b, and the conductive layer 1409 .
- the conductive layer 1409 is provided to overlap with the gate electrode layer 1401 with the insulating layer 1407 interposed therebetween.
- the conductive layer 1409 can be formed using a material similar to that of the gate electrode layer 1401 or the source and drain electrode layers 1405 a and 1405 b by a method similar thereto. In the case where a pixel electrode layer is provided, the conductive layer 1409 may be formed using a material similar to that of the pixel electrode layer by a method similar thereto. In this embodiment, a stack of a titanium film, an aluminum film, and a titanium film is used as the conductive layer 1409 .
- the conductive layer 1409 may have the same potential as the gate electrode layer 1401 or have potential different from that of the gate electrode layer 1401 and can function as a second gate electrode layer. Further, the conductive layer 1409 may be in a floating state.
- the conductive layer 1409 in a portion overlapping with the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 , in a bias-temperature stress test (hereinafter, referred to as a BT test) for examining reliability of a thin film transistor, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of the thin film transistor 1431 between before and after the BT test can be reduced.
- a bias-temperature stress test hereinafter, referred to as a BT test
- FIG. 35B illustrates an example partly different from FIG. 35A .
- the same portion and a step as, or a portion having function similar to those illustrated in FIG. 35A can be made in a manner similar to that illustrated in FIG. 35A ; therefore, repetitive description is omitted.
- a thin film transistor 1432 illustrated in FIG. 35B is an example having a structure in which the conductive layer 1409 is provided to overlap with the gate electrode layer 1401 and a channel region of the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 with the channel protective layer 1418 , the insulating layer 1407 , and an insulating layer 1408 interposed between the conductive layer 1409 and the gate electrode layer 1401 .
- the insulating layer 1408 functioning as a planarization film is stacked over the insulating layer 1407 .
- FIG. 35B shows a structure in which source and drain regions are not provided, and the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 is directly in contact with the source electrode layer 1405 a and the drain electrode layer 1405 b.
- the conductive layer 1409 is provided in a portion overlapping with the oxide semiconductor layer 1403 in the structure of FIG. 35B similar to FIG. 35A , whereby in a bias-temperature stress test for examining reliability of a thin film transistor, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of the thin film transistor 1432 between before and after the BT test can be reduced.
- Embodiment 1 an example of a structure which is partly different from that of Embodiment 1 will be described with reference to FIG. 36 .
- the same portion as or a portion having a function similar to those described in Embodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described in Embodiment 1, and also the steps similar to those of Embodiment 1 can be performed in a manner similar to those described in Embodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted.
- heat treatment is performed under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure, and then slow cooling is performed.
- an inert gas such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon
- Heat treatment performed on the first oxide semiconductor layer under the above atmosphere makes it possible to eliminate impurities such as hydrogen and moisture in an oxide semiconductor layer 403 .
- layer or a buffer layer) of a thin film transistor is formed over the first oxide semiconductor layer and then a conductive film is formed.
- the first oxide semiconductor layer, the second oxide semiconductor film, and the conductive film are selectively etched through an etching step to form the oxide semiconductor layer 403 , source and drain regions 404 a and 404 b (also referred to as n + layers or buffer layers), and the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b.
- the oxide semiconductor layer 403 is partly etched to have a groove portion (a recessed portion).
- a silicon oxide film as the oxide insulating film 407 is formed in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer 403 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method.
- the oxide insulating film 407 formed in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer does not include impurities such as moisture, a hydrogen ion, and OH ⁇ and is formed using an inorganic insulating film which blocks entry of these impurities from the outside, specifically, a silicon oxide film or a silicon nitride oxide film.
- the oxide insulating film 407 When the oxide insulating film 407 is formed in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 403 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method, or the like, in the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 403 , at least a region in contact with the oxide insulating film 407 has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1 ⁇ 10 18 /cm 3 , more preferably 1 ⁇ 10 14 /cm 3 or lower). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be provided.
- the oxide semiconductor layer has a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region.
- a thin film transistor 473 can be completed (see FIG. 36 ).
- an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is used for the source and drain regions (also referred to as n + layers or buffer layers) 404 a and 404 b.
- the source region is provided between the oxide semiconductor layer 403 and the source electrode layer
- the drain region is provided between the oxide semiconductor layer 403 and the drain electrode layer.
- an oxide semiconductor layer having an n-type conductivity is used as the source and drain regions.
- the second oxide semiconductor film used for the source and drain regions 404 a and 404 b of the thin film transistor 473 is preferably thinner than the first oxide semiconductor layer used for a channel formation region and preferably has conductivity (electrical conductivity) higher than the first oxide semiconductor layer.
- the first oxide semiconductor layer used for the channel formation region has an amorphous structure and the second oxide semiconductor film used for the source region and the drain region includes a crystal grain (nanocrystal) in an amorphous structure in some cases.
- the crystal grain (nanocrystal) in the second oxide semiconductor film used for the source region and the drain region has a diameter of 1 nm to 10 nm, typically about 2 nm to 4 nm.
- the thin film transistor 473 may be subjected to heat treatment (preferably at a temperature higher than or equal to 150° C. and lower than 350° C.) under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air). For example, heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for one hour. In such heat treatment, the oxide semiconductor layer 403 in a condition of being in contact with the oxide insulating film 407 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of the thin film transistor 473 can be reduced.
- FIG. 42 illustrates a model of an oxide semiconductor layer which was used for the simulation.
- a structure in which a layer 1203 having low oxygen density and a layer 1205 having high oxygen density were stacked was employed for an oxide semiconductor layer 1201 .
- the layer 1203 having low oxygen density was formed to have an amorphous structure including In atoms, Ga atoms, Zn atoms, and O atoms, where the numbers of In atoms, Ga atoms, and Zn atoms were each 15 and the number of O atoms was 54.
- the layer 1205 having high oxygen density was formed to have an amorphous structure including In atoms, Ga atoms, Zn atoms, and O atoms, where the numbers of In atoms, Ga atoms, and Zn atoms were each 15 and the number of O atoms was 66.
- the density of the oxide semiconductor layer 1201 was set to 5.9 g/cm 3 .
- the classical molecular dynamics (MD) simulation was performed on the oxide semiconductor layer 1201 under conditions of NVT ensemble and a temperature of 250° C.
- the time step was set to 0.2 fs, and the total simulation time was set to 200 ps.
- Born- Mayer-Huggins potential was used for the potentials of metal-oxygen bonding and oxygen-oxygen bonding.
- movement of atoms at an upper end portion and a lower end portion of the oxide semiconductor layer 1201 was fixed.
- the simulation results are shown in FIG. 43 .
- the range of 0 nm to 1.15 nm indicates the layer 1203 having low oxygen density
- the range of 1.15 nm to 2.3 nm indicates the layer 1205 having high oxygen density.
- the distribution of oxygen densities before the MD simulation is indicated by a solid line 1207
- the distribution of oxygen densities after the MD simulation is indicated by a dashed line 1209 .
- the solid line 1207 shows that the oxide semiconductor layer 1201 has high oxygen densities in a region ranging from an interface between the layer 1203 having low oxygen density and the layer 1205 having high oxygen density to the layer 1205 having high oxygen concentration.
- the dashed line 1209 shows that the oxygen density is uniform in the layer 1203 having low oxygen density and the layer 1205 having high oxygen density.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Microelectronics & Electronic Packaging (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Manufacturing & Machinery (AREA)
- Computer Hardware Design (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Power Engineering (AREA)
- Condensed Matter Physics & Semiconductors (AREA)
- Thin Film Transistor (AREA)
- Electrodes Of Semiconductors (AREA)
- Liquid Crystal (AREA)
- Electroluminescent Light Sources (AREA)
- Dram (AREA)
- Physical Deposition Of Substances That Are Components Of Semiconductor Devices (AREA)
- Devices For Indicating Variable Information By Combining Individual Elements (AREA)
Abstract
Description
- The present invention relates to a semiconductor device including an oxide semiconductor and a manufacturing method thereof.
- In this specification, a semiconductor device generally means a device which can function by utilizing semiconductor characteristics, and an electrooptic device, a semiconductor circuit, and an electronic appliance are all semiconductor devices.
- In recent years, a technique for forming a thin film transistor (TFT) by using a semiconductor thin film (having a thickness of approximately several nanometers to several hundred nanometers) formed over a substrate having an insulating surface has attracted attention. Thin film transistors are applied to a wide range of electronic devices such as ICs or electro-optical devices, and prompt development of thin film transistors that are to be used as switching elements in image display devices, in particular, is being pushed. Various metal oxides are used for a variety of applications. Indium oxide is a well-known material and is used as a transparent electrode material which is necessary for liquid crystal displays and the like.
- Some metal oxides have semiconductor characteristics. Examples of such metal oxides having semiconductor characteristics include tungsten oxide, tin oxide, indium oxide, and zinc oxide. Thin film transistors including such metal oxide having semiconductor characteristics in its channel formation region have been proposed (
Patent Documents 1 to 4 and Non-Patent Document 1). - Examples of metal oxides include not only an oxide of a single metal element but also an oxide of a plurality of metal elements (multi-component oxides). For example, InGaO3(ZnO)m (m is a natural number) which is a homologous compound is a known material as multi-component oxides including In, Ga, and Zn (
Non-Patent Documents 2 to 4). - In addition, it has been proved that an oxide semiconductor including such an In—Ga—Zn based oxide can be used as a channel layer of a thin film transistor (
Patent Document 5, andNon-Patent Documents 5 and 6). -
- [Patent Document 1] Japanese Published Patent Application No. S60-198861
- [Patent Document 2] Japanese Published Patent Application No. H8-264794
- [Patent Document 3] Japanese Translation of PCT International Application No. H11-505377
- [Patent Document 4] Japanese Published Patent Application No. 2000-150900
- [Patent Document 5] Japanese Published Patent Application No. 2004-103957
-
- [Non-Patent Document 1] M. W. Prins, K. O. Grosse-Holz, G. Muller, J. F. M. Cillessen, J. B. Giesbers, R. P. Weening, and R. M. Wolf, “A ferroelectric transparent thin-film transistor”, Appl. Phys. Lett., 17 Jun. 1996, Vol. 68 pp. 3650-3652
- [Non-Patent Document 2] M. Nakamura, N. Kimizuka, and T. Mohri, “The Phase Relations in the In2O3—Ga2ZnO4—ZnO System at 1350° C.”, J. Solid State Chem., 1991, Vol. 93, pp. 298-315
- [Non-Patent Document 3] N. Kimizuka, M. Isobe, and M. Nakamura, “Syntheses and Single-Crystal Data of Homologous Compounds, In2O3(ZnO)m (m=3, 4, and 5), InGaO3(ZnO)3, and Ga2O3(ZnO)m (m=7, 8, 9, and 16) in the In2O3—ZnGa2O4—ZnO System”, J. Solid State Chem., 1995, Vol. 116, pp. 170-178
- [Non-Patent Document 4] M. Nakamura, N. Kimizuka, T. Mohri, and M. Isobe, “Homologous Series, Synthesis and Crystal Structure of InFeO3(ZnO)m (m: natural number) and its Isostructural Compound”, KOTAI BUTSURI (SOLID STATE PHYSICS), 1993, Vol. 28, No. 5, pp. 317-327
- [Non-Patent Document 5] K. Nomura, H. Ohta, K. Ueda, T. Kamiya, M. Hirano, and H. Hosono, “Thin-film transistor fabricated in single-crystalline transparent oxide semiconductor”, SCIENCE, 2003, Vol. 300, pp. 1269-1272
- [Non-Patent Document 6] K. Nomura, H. Ohta, A. Takagi, T. Kamiya, M. Hirano, and H. Hosono, “Room-temperature fabrication of transparent flexible thin-film transistors using amorphous oxide semiconductors”, NATURE, 2004, Vol. 432 pp. 488-492
- It is an object to provide a highly reliable semiconductor device including a thin film transistor whose electric characteristics are stable.
- In a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device including a thin film transistor in which an oxide semiconductor film is used for a semiconductor layer including a channel formation region, heat treatment (which is for dehydration or dehydrogenation) is performed so as to improve the purity of the oxide semiconductor film and reduce impurities such as moisture. Besides impurities such as moisture existing in the oxide semiconductor film, heat treatment causes reduction of impurities such as moisture existing in the gate insulating layer and those in interfaces between the oxide semiconductor film and films which are provided over and below the oxide semiconductor film and are in contact with the oxide semiconductor film.
- In order to reduce impurities such as moisture, after formation of the oxide semiconductor film, heat treatment is performed under an inert-gas atmosphere of nitrogen or a rare gas such as argon or helium or under reduced pressure, at 200° C. or higher, preferably, 400° C. to 600° C. inclusive. In the heat treatment, the formed oxide semiconductor film is exposed. As a result, impurities such as moisture, which are contained in the oxide semiconductor film, are reduced. After heat treatment, slow cooling is performed to a temperature which is equal to or higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C. under an inert-gas atmosphere.
- Use of an oxide semiconductor film in which contained moisture is reduced by heat treatment performed under an inert-gas atmosphere of nitrogen, argon, or the like or under reduced pressure allows improvement of electric characteristics of a thin film transistor and achievement of both mass productivity and high performance thereof.
- Heat treatment was performed on a plurality of samples under a nitrogen atmosphere at heat temperatures whose conditions were determined. Such a plurality of samples were measured with thermal desorption spectroscopy (TDS). Measurement results are shown in
FIG. 2 ,FIG. 3 , andFIG. 4 . - The thermal desorption spectroscopy apparatus is used for detecting and identifying a gas component discharged or generated from the samples by a quadrupole mass analyzer; thus, a gas and a molecule discharged from surfaces and insides of the samples can be observed. Discharge or generation of gas from the samples occurs while the samples are heated and the temperature is rising in high vacuum. With use of a thermal desorption spectrometer (product name: EMD-WA1000S) manufactured by ESCO Ltd., measurement was performed under a condition where the rising temperature was at approximately 10° C./min., the SEM voltage was set to 1500 V, the dwell time was 0.2 (sec), and the number of channels to be used was 23. In addition, during the measurement, the pressure was at a degree of vacuum of about 1×10−7 (Pa). Note that the ionization coefficient, the fragmentation coefficient, the pass-through coefficient, and the pumping rate of H2O were respectively 1.0, 0.805, 1.56, and 1.0.
-
FIG. 2 is a graph showing TDS results of comparison between a sample (comparative sample) which includes only a glass substrate and a sample (Sample 1) where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm (an actual thickness obtained after etching is about 30 nm) is formed over a glass substrate.FIG. 2 shows results obtained by measuring H2O. Discharge of impurities such as moisture (H2O) from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film can be confirmed from a peak in the vicinity of 300° C. -
FIG. 3 is a graph showing comparison of samples, which shows TDS measurement results of H2O. The comparison was performed on the following samples: the sample (Sample 1) where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm is formed over a glass substrate; a sample (Sample 2) where the structure ofSample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 350° C. under an air atmosphere; and a sample (Sample 3) where the structure ofSample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 350° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. From the results shown inFIG. 3 , a peak in the vicinity of 300° C. ofSample 3 is lower than that ofSample 2. Thus, discharge of moisture (H2O) due to heat treatment performed under a nitrogen atmosphere can be confirmed. Moreover, it is found that heat treatment performed under a nitrogen atmosphere reduces impurities such as moisture (H2O) more than heat treatment performed under an air atmosphere. -
FIG. 4 is a graph showing comparison of samples, which shows TDS measurement results of H2O. The comparison was performed on the following samples: the sample (Sample 1) where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm is formed over a glass substrate; a sample (Sample 4) where the structure ofSample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 250° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere; the sample (Sample 3) where the structure ofSample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 350° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere; a sample (Sample 5) where the structure ofSample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for an hour at 450° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere; and a sample (Sample 6) where the structure ofSample 1 is subjected to heat treatment for 10 hours at 350° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. From the results shown inFIG. 4 , it is found that the higher the heat temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere is, the smaller the amount of impurities such as moisture (H2O) discharged from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film becomes. - In addition, from the graphs of
FIG. 3 andFIG. 4 , two peaks can be confirmed: a first peak in the vicinity of 200° C. to 250° C., which indicates discharge of impurities such as moisture (H2O); and a second peak at 300° C. or higher, which indicates discharge of impurities such as moisture (H2O). - Note that even in the case where the sample which has been subjected to heat treatment at 450° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere is left at room temperature in an air atmosphere approximately for one week, discharge of moisture at 200° C. or higher was not observed. Thus, it is found that by performing heat treatment, the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film becomes stable.
- Further,
FIG. 1 shows measurement results of carrier concentrations. Conditions of heat temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere were set to 150° C., 175° C., 200° C., 225° C., 250° C., 275° C., 300° C., 325° C., 350° C., 375° C., 400° C., 425° C., and 450° C., and a carrier concentration at each temperature was measured. -
FIG. 5A illustrates a three-dimensional view of a property-evaluation sample 510 for evaluating properties (the carrier concentrations and Hall mobility) of an oxide semiconductor film (an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film). The property-evaluation sample 510 was fabricated and subjected to Hall effect measurement at room temperature. The carrier concentration and Hall mobility of the oxide semiconductor film were evaluated. The property-evaluation sample 510 was fabricated in the following manner: an insulatingfilm 501 including silicon oxynitride was formed over asubstrate 500, anoxide semiconductor film 502 with a size of 10 mm×10 mm, which serves as an evaluation object, was formed over the insulatingfilm 501, andelectrodes 503 to 506 each having a diameter of 1 mm were formed over theoxide semiconductor film 502. The carrier concentrations of the oxide semiconductor film obtained by the Hall effect measurement are shown inFIG. 1 , the Hall mobility thereof is shown inFIG. 5B , and conductivity thereof is shown inFIG. 5C . - From the results of
FIG. 1 ,FIG. 2 ,FIG. 3 , andFIG. 4 , it is found that there is a relation, at 250° C. or higher in TDS measurement, between discharge of impurities such as moisture (H2O) from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film and change in carrier concentration. When the impurities such as moisture (H2O) are discharged from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film, the carrier concentration is increased. - Moreover, H, O, OH, H2, O2, N, N2, and Ar, in addition to H2O, were each measured by TDS. The measurement resulted in that peaks of H2O, H, O, and OH were observed clearly but peaks of H2, O2, N, N2, and Ar were not observed. As samples of the above measurement, a structure where an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film with a set thickness of 50 nm was formed over a glass substrate was used. The conditions of heat treatment were set as follows: heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for an hour; that under a nitrogen atmosphere at 350° C. for an hour; that under a nitrogen atmosphere at 350° C. for ten hours; and that in a nitrogen atmosphere at 450° C. for an hour. As comparative samples, a structure in which heat treatment was not performed on an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film and a structure including only a glass substrate were measured.
FIG. 37 ,FIG. 38 ,FIG. 39 , andFIG. 40 show TDS results of H, O, OH, and H2, respectively. Note that under the above conditions of heat treatment, the oxygen concentration under a nitrogen atmosphere is 20 ppm or lower. - According to the above results, it is found that by performance of heat treatment of the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film, moisture (H2O) is mainly discharged. In other words, heat treatment causes discharge of moisture (H2O) mainly from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film. The TDS measurement values of H shown in
FIG. 37 , O shown inFIG. 38 , and OH shown inFIG. 39 are affected by materials obtained by decomposition of water molecules. Note that hydrogen and OH which are considered to be contained in the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film are discharged together by heat treatment. - In this specification, heat treatment performed under an inert-gas atmosphere of nitrogen or an inert gas such as argon or helium or under reduced pressure is referred to as heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation. In this specification, “dehydrogenation” does not indicate elimination of only H2 by heat treatment. For convenience, elimination of H, OH, and the like is referred to as “dehydration or dehydrogenation”.
- Impurities (H2O) contained in an oxide semiconductor layer is reduced and the carrier concentration are increased by heat treatment performed under an inert gas, and then slow cooling is performed. After slow cooling, the carrier concentration in the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced by formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer or the like, which leads to improvement in reliability.
- By heat treatment performed under a nitrogen atmosphere, resistance of an oxide semiconductor layer is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1×1018/cm3 or higher), so that a low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer can be obtained. After that, if an oxide insulating film is formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer, in the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer, at least a region in contact with the oxide insulating film can have increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3, more preferably 1×1014/cm3 or lower). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained. During a manufacturing process of a semiconductor device, it is important to increase and decrease the carrier concentration in the oxide semiconductor layer by performance of heat treatment under an inert-gas atmosphere (or reduced pressure), slow cooling, formation of an oxide insulating film, and the like. In other words, heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed on an oxide semiconductor layer, which results in that the oxide semiconductor layer becomes an oxygen-deficiency type and be turned into an n-type (such as n− or n+-type) oxide semiconductor layer. Then, by formation of an oxide insulating film, the oxide semiconductor layer is in an oxygen-excess state and to be an i-type oxide semiconductor layer. When an oxide insulating film is formed over the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film, a carrier concentration of 1×1014/cm3 or lower, which is indicated by a dotted
line 10 inFIG. 1 , is obtained. In this manner, a semiconductor device including a thin film transistor having high electric characteristics and high reliability can be provided. - Note that as the oxide insulating film formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer, an inorganic insulating film which blocks impurities such as moisture, hydrogen ions, and OH− is used. Specifically, a silicon oxide film or a silicon nitride oxide film is used.
- In addition, after the oxide insulating film serving as a protective film is formed to be over and in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer, second heat treatment may be performed. In the case where second heat treatment is performed after formation of the oxide insulating film serving as a protective film to be over and in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer, variation in electric characteristics of thin film transistors can be reduced.
- One embodiment of the present invention disclosed in this specification is a semiconductor device including a gate electrode layer, a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, and an insulating layer over the oxide semiconductor layer. The gate insulating layer, the oxide semiconductor layer, the insulating layer, an interface between the gate insulating layer and the oxide semiconductor layer, and an interface between the oxide semiconductor layer and the insulating layer have a hydrogen concentration of 3×1020 cm−3 or lower.
- Moisture contained in the oxide semiconductor layer includes a variety of forms such as moisture (H2O), M-OH, M-H, and the like as well as hydrogen. An average value or a peak value of the hydrogen concentration which is the absolute quantity is 3×1020 cm−3 or lower, preferably 1×1020 cm−3 or lower.
- Such a concentration range can be obtained by secondary ion mass spectrometry (SIMS) or on the basis of data of SIMS.
- With the above structure, at least one of the above problems can be resolved.
- One embodiment of the present invention to realize the above structure is a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device including the steps of forming a gate electrode layer, forming a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, forming an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, performing dehydration or dehydrogenation on the oxide semiconductor layer, forming a source electrode layer and a drain electrode layer over the dehydrated or dehydrogenated oxide semiconductor layer, and forming an oxide insulating film which is in contact with a part of the oxide semiconductor layer and over the gate insulating layer, the oxide semiconductor layer, the source electrode layer, and the drain electrode layer. Note that dehydration or dehydrogenation is heat treatment performed under a nitrogen atmosphere or a rare gas atmosphere or under reduced pressure.
- Another embodiment of the present invention to realize the above structure is a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device including the steps of forming a gate electrode layer, forming a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, forming an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, heating the oxide semiconductor layer under an inert atmosphere to increase a carrier concentration, forming a source electrode layer and a drain electrode layer over the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is increased, and forming an oxide insulating film which is in contact with a part of the heated oxide semiconductor layer and over the gate insulating layer, the heated oxide semiconductor layer, the source electrode layer, and the drain electrode layer, so that a carrier concentration is reduced. Note that after the oxide semiconductor layer is heated under an inert atmosphere at a temperature of 400° C. or higher, slow cooling is performed to a temperature which is equal to higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C.
- Another embodiment of the present invention to realize the above structure is a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device including the steps of forming a gate electrode layer, forming a gate insulating layer over the gate electrode layer, forming an oxide semiconductor layer over the gate insulating layer, heating the oxide semiconductor layer under a reduced pressure to increase a carrier concentration, forming a source electrode layer and a drain electrode layer over the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is increased, and forming an oxide insulating film which is in contact with a part of the heated oxide semiconductor layer and over the gate insulating layer, the heated oxide semiconductor layer, and the source electrode layer, and the drain electrode layer, so that a carrier concentration is reduced.
- In each structure formed by the above manufacturing method, the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is increased is 1×1018/cm3 or higher. The carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer whose carrier concentration is reduced due to formation of the oxide insulating film is lower than 1×1018/cm3, preferably 1×1014/cm3 or lower.
- The oxide semiconductor used in this specification is, for example, a thin film expressed by InMO3(ZnO)m (m>0), and a thin film transistor using the thin film as a semiconductor layer is manufactured. Note that M denotes one metal element or a plurality of metal elements selected from Ga, Fe, Ni, Mn, and Co. For example, M denotes Ga in some cases; meanwhile, M denotes the above metal element such as Ni or Fe in addition to Ga (Ga and Ni or Ga and Fe) in other cases. Further, the above oxide semiconductor may include Fe or Ni, another transitional metal element, or an oxide of the transitional metal as an impurity element in addition to the metal element included as M. In this specification, an oxide semiconductor whose composition formula is represented as InMO3(ZnO)m (m>0) where at least Ga is included as M is referred to as an In-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor, and a thin film thereof is also referred to as an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film.
- As the oxide semiconductor which is applied to the oxide semiconductor layer, any of the following oxide semiconductors can be applied in addition to the above: an In-Sn-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-Al-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an Al-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-Al-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-Ga-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an Al-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor; an In-O-based oxide semiconductor; a Sn-O-based oxide semiconductor; and a Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor. Moreover, silicon oxide may be included in the above oxide semiconductor layer. Addition of silicon oxide (SiOx (x>0)) which hinders crystallization into the oxide semiconductor layer can suppress crystallization of the oxide semiconductor layer in the case where heat treatment is performed after formation of the oxide semiconductor layer in the manufacturing process. Note that the preferable state of the oxide semiconductor layer is amorphous, or partial crystallization thereof is acceptable.
- The oxide semiconductor preferably includes In, further preferably, includes In and Ga. Dehydration or dehydrogenation is effective in a process of forming an i-type (intrinsic) oxide semiconductor layer.
- Since a thin film transistor is easily broken due to static electricity or the like, a protective circuit for protecting the driver circuit is preferably provided over the same substrate as a gate line or a source line. The protective circuit is preferably formed with a non-linear element including an oxide semiconductor.
- Further, treatment of the gate insulating layer and the oxide semiconductor film may be successively performed without exposure to air. Such treatment is also called successive treatment, an in-situ step, or successive film formation. Successive treatment without exposure to air enables an interface between the gate insulating layer and the oxide semiconductor film to be formed without being contaminated by atmospheric components or contamination impurities floating in the air, such as moisture or hydrocarbon. Thus, variation in characteristics of thin film transistors can be reduced.
- Note that the term “successive treatment” in this specification means that during the process from a first treatment step performed by a PCVD method or a sputtering method to a second treatment step performed by a PCVD method or a sputtering method, an atmosphere in which a substrate to be processed is disposed is not contaminated by a contaminant atmosphere such as air, and is constantly controlled to be vacuum or an inert-gas atmosphere (a nitrogen atmosphere or a rare gas atmosphere). By the successive treatment, treatment such as film formation can be performed while moisture or the like is prevented from attaching again to the substrate to be processed which is cleaned.
- Performing the process from the first treatment step to the second treatment step in the same chamber is within the scope of the successive treatment in this specification. Further, the case where the process from the first treatment step to the second treatment is performed in different chambers in the following manner is also within the scope of the successive treatment in this specification: the substrate is transferred after the first treatment step to another chamber without being exposed to air and subjected to the second treatment.
- Note that the case where there is the following step between the first treatment step and the second treatment step is also within the scope of the successive treatment in this specification: a substrate transfer step, an alignment step, a slow cooling step, a heating or cooling a substrate step which is for setting the substrate to have temperature suitable to the second film formation step, or the like.
- However, the following case is not within the scope of the successive treatment in this specification: there is a step in which liquid is used, such as a cleaning step, a wet etching step, or a resist formation step between the first treatment step and the second treatment step.
- A thin film transistor having stable electric characteristics can be provided. Further, a semiconductor device which includes thin film transistors having excellent electric characteristics and high reliability can be provided.
-
FIG. 1 is a graph showing the carrier concentration of an oxide semiconductor layer with respect to heating temperatures. -
FIG. 2 is a graph showing TDS measurement results. -
FIG. 3 is a graph showing TDS measurement results. -
FIG. 4 is a graph showing TDS measurement results. -
FIG. 5A is a three-dimensional view of a property-evaluation sample,FIG. 5B is a graph showing results of Hall effect measurement of an oxide semiconductor layer, andFIG. 5C is a graph showing conductivity. -
FIGS. 6A to 6D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIGS. 7A and 7B illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIGS. 8A to 8D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIGS. 9A and 9B illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIGS. 10A to 10D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIGS. 11A to 11C are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIG. 12 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. - FIGS. 13A1 and 13A2 and FIGS. 13B1 and 13B2 illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention.
-
FIG. 14 is a cross-sectional view of an electric furnace. -
FIG. 15 illustrates a semiconductor device. - FIGS. 16A1 and 16A2 and 16B illustrate a semiconductor device.
-
FIGS. 17A and 17B illustrate a semiconductor device. -
FIG. 18 illustrates a pixel equivalent circuit of a semiconductor device. -
FIGS. 19A to 19C illustrate a semiconductor device. -
FIGS. 20A and 20B are each a block diagram of a semiconductor device. -
FIG. 21 illustrates a configuration of a signal line driver circuit. -
FIG. 22 is a timing chart of operation of a signal line driver circuit. -
FIG. 23 is a timing chart illustrating operation of a signal line driver circuit. -
FIG. 24 illustrates a configuration of a shift register. -
FIG. 25 illustrates a connection structure of a flip-flop ofFIG. 24 . -
FIG. 26 illustrates a semiconductor device. -
FIG. 27 is an external view illustrating an example of an e-book reader. -
FIGS. 28A and 28B are external views respectively illustrating an example of a television set and an example of a digital photo frame. -
FIGS. 29A and 29B are external views illustrating examples of game machines. -
FIGS. 30A and 30B are external views illustrating an example of a portable computer and an example of a mobile phone, respectively. -
FIGS. 31A to 31D illustrate a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device. -
FIG. 32 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIG. 33 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIGS. 34A to 34C illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIGS. 35A and 35B illustrate a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIG. 36 illustrates a semiconductor device of one embodiment of the present invention. -
FIG. 37 is a graph showing TDS results about H. -
FIG. 38 is a graph showing TDS results about O. -
FIG. 39 is a graph showing TDS results about OH. -
FIG. 40 is a graph showing TDS results about H2. -
FIGS. 41A to 41C are graphs each showing Vg-Id characteristics of a thin film transistor before and after a BT test. -
FIG. 42 is a view illustrating a structure of an oxide semiconductor layer used for calculation. -
FIG. 43 is a graph describing calculation results of the oxygen density in an oxide semiconductor layer. - Hereinafter, embodiments of the present invention will be described in detail with reference to the accompanying drawings. However, the present invention is not limited to the description below, and it is easily understood by those skilled in the art that modes and details disclosed herein can be modified in various ways without departing from the spirit and the scope of the present invention. Therefore, the present invention is not construed as being limited to description of the embodiments.
- A semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to
FIGS. 6A to 6D andFIGS. 7A and 7B . -
FIG. 7A is a top view of athin film transistor 470 of a semiconductor device, andFIG. 7B is a cross-sectional view along line C1-C2 ofFIG. 7A . Thethin film transistor 470 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over asubstrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, agate electrode layer 401, agate insulating layer 402, asemiconductor layer 403, and source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b. In addition, anoxide insulating film 407 is provided to cover thethin film transistor 470 and be in contact with thesemiconductor layer 403. - The
semiconductor layer 403 formed using an oxide semiconductor film is subjected to heat treatment (heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation) for reducing impurities such as moisture and the like at least after formation of the oxide semiconductor film, so that resistance is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1×1018/cm3 or higher). After that, theoxide insulating film 407 is formed to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor film, so that the oxide semiconductor film has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3, more preferably 1×1014/cm3 or lower). Accordingly, the oxide semiconductor film can be used as a channel formation region. - After elimination of impurities such as moisture (H2O) by performance of heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, it is preferable that slow cooling be performed under an inert atmosphere. After the heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation and the slow cooling, the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced by formation of an oxide insulating film to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer or the like, which improves reliability of the
thin film transistor 470. - Besides impurities such as moisture inside the
semiconductor layer 403, the heat treatment causes reduction in impurities such as moisture inside thegate insulating layer 402 and in interfaces provided between thesemiconductor layer 403 formed using an oxide semiconductor and films which are over and below thesemiconductor layer 403 to be in contact therewith. Specifically, the interfaces indicate an interface between thegate insulating layer 402 and thesemiconductor layer 403 and an interface between theoxide insulating film 407 and thesemiconductor layer 403. - Here, an example showing results of the reliability test of the
thin film transistor 470 is described with reference toFIGS. 41A to 41C . - One of methods for examining reliability of thin film transistors is a bias-temperature stress test (hereinafter, referred to as a BT test). The BT test is one kind of an accelerated test and can evaluate change in characteristics, caused by long-term usage, of thin film transistors in a short time. In particular, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of the thin film transistor between before and after the BT test is an important indicator for examining reliability. Between before and after the BT test, the small amount of shift in threshold voltage means high reliability.
- Specifically, the temperature of a substrate over which a thin film transistor is formed (substrate temperature) is set at fixed temperature, a source and a drain of the thin film transistor are set at the same potential, and a gate is supplied with potential different from those of the source and the drain for a certain period. The substrate temperature may be set as appropriate in accordance with the purpose of the test. A test in the case where potential applied to the gate is higher than potentials of the source and the drain is referred to as a +BT test, and a test in the case where potential applied to the gate is lower than potentials of the source and the drain is referred to as a −BT test.
- The stress conditions for the BT test can be determined by setting the substrate temperature, electric field intensity applied to a gate insulating film, or a time period of application of electric field. The electric field intensity applied to a gate insulating film can be determined by dividing the potential difference between the gate potential and the source and drain potential by the thickness of the gate insulating film. For example, in the case where the electric field intensity applied to the 100-nm-thick gate insulating film is to be set to 2 MV/cm, the potential difference may be set to 20 V.
- In this embodiment, results of a BT test performed on three kinds of samples are described. The samples are subjected to heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C., 350° C., and 450° C., which is performed before formation of source and drain in manufacture of a thin film transistor.
- Note that “voltage” generally indicates a difference between potentials of two points, and “potential” indicates a static electric energy (electrical potential energy) unit charge which is at a point in a static electric field has. However, in an electronic circuit, a difference between a potential at a certain point and a reference potential (e.g., a ground potential) is often referred to as the potential at a certain point. Thus, in this specification, when a difference between a potential at a certain point and a reference potential (e.g., a ground potential) is referred to as the potential at a certain point, the potential at a certain point means the voltage except for the case where definition is particularly given.
- As the BT test, a +BT test and a −BT test were performed under such conditions that a substrate temperature was 150° C., an electric field intensity applied to a gate insulating film was 2 MV/cm, and a time period for application was one hour.
- First, the +BT test is described. In order to measure initial characteristics of a thin film transistor subjected to the BT test, a change in characteristics of the source-drain current (hereinafter, referred to as the drain current) was measured, under the conditions where the substrate temperature was set to 40° C., the voltage between source and drain (hereinafter, the drain voltage) was set to 10 V, and the voltage between source and gate (hereinafter, the gate voltage) was changed in the range of −20 V to +20 V. That is, Vg-Id characteristics were measured. Here, as a countermeasure against moisture-absorption onto surfaces of the samples, the substrate temperature was set to 40° C. However, the measurement may be performed at room temperature (25° C.) or lower if there is no particular problem.
- Next, the substrate temperature was increased to 150° C., and then, the potentials of the source and the drain of the thin film transistor were set to 0 V. After that, the voltage was applied to the gate so that the electric field intensity applied to the gate insulating film was 2 MV/cm. In this case, the thickness of the gate insulating film of the thin film transistor was 100 nm. The gate was supplied with +20 V of voltage, and the gate supplied with the voltage was kept for one hour. Note that although the time period for voltage application was one hour here, the time period may be changed as appropriate in accordance with the purpose.
- Next, the substrate temperature was lowered to 40° C. while the voltage was kept on being applied to the source, the drain, and the gate. If application of the voltage is stopped before the substrate temperature was completely lowered to 40° C., the thin film transistor which has been damaged during the BT test is repaired by the influence of residual heat. Thus, lowering of the substrate temperature needs to be performed with application of the voltage. After the substrate temperature was lowered to 40° C., application of the voltage was terminated.
- Then, the Vg-Id characteristics were measured under the conditions same as those for the measurement of the initial characteristics, so that the Vg-Id characteristics after the +BT test were obtained.
- Next, the −BT test is described. The −BT test was performed with the procedure similar to the +BT test, but has a different point from the +BT test, in that the voltage applied to the gate after the substrate temperature is increased to 150° C. is set to −20 V.
- In the BT test, it is important to use a thin film transistor which has been never subjected to a BT test. For example, if a −BT test is performed with use of a thin film transistor which has been once subjected to a +BT test, the results of the −BT test cannot be evaluated correctly due to influence of the +BT test which has been performed previously. Similarly, if the thin film transistor which has been once subjected to a +BT test is used for another +BT test, the results cannot be evaluated correctly. However, the usage of the thin film transistor is not limited to the above in the case where the BT test is performed repeatedly in consideration of such influence.
-
FIGS. 41A to 41C show the Vg-Id characteristics before and after the BT tests.FIG. 41A shows the BT test results of thin film transistors each formed in such a manner that heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. before formation of a source and a drain.FIG. 41B shows the BT test results of thin film transistors each formed in such a manner that heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 350° C. before formation of a source and a drain.FIG. 41C shows the BT test results of thin film transistors each formed in such a manner that heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 450° C. before formation of a source and a drain. - In each graph, the horizontal axis represents the gate voltage (Vg) which is shown with a logarithmic scale, and the vertical axis represents the drain current (Id) which is shown with a logarithmic scale.
Initial characteristics BTs BTs - According to
FIGS. 41A to 41C , it is found that as compared to the threshold voltages of theinitial characteristics BTs BTs FIG. 41B is smaller than that at 250° C. ofFIG. 41A and that the shift amount at 450° C. ofFIG. 41C is smaller than that at 350° C. ofFIG. 41B . That is, the higher the temperature of heat treatment which is performed before formation of a source and a drain is made, the smaller the amount of shift in the threshold voltage after +BT tests becomes. - The temperature of heat treatment at 450° C. or higher can improve reliability in at least the +BT tests. It is found that there is a relation between elimination of impurities such as moisture (H2O) from the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film and the results of the BT stress tests.
- The source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b in contact with the
semiconductor layer 403 which is an oxide semiconductor layer is formed using one or more materials selected from titanium, aluminum, manganese, magnesium, zirconium, and beryllium. Further, an alloy film including these elements in combination, and the like, may be stacked. - The
semiconductor layer 403 including a channel formation region may be formed using an oxide material having semiconductor characteristics. Typically, an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is used. -
FIGS. 6A to 6D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of thethin film transistor 470. - In
FIG. 6A , thegate electrode layer 401 is provided over thesubstrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface. An insulating film serving as a base film may be provided between thesubstrate 400 and thegate electrode layer 401. The base film has a function of preventing diffusion of an impurity element from thesubstrate 400, and can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using one or more of a silicon nitride film, a silicon oxide film, a silicon nitride oxide film, and a silicon oxynitride film. Thegate electrode layer 401 can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using a metal material such as molybdenum, titanium, chromium, tantalum, tungsten, aluminum, copper, neodymium, or scandium, or an alloy material which contains any of these materials as its main component. - For example, as a two-layer structure of the
gate electrode layer 401, the following structures are preferable: a two-layer structure of an aluminum layer and a molybdenum layer stacked thereover, a two-layer structure of a copper layer and a molybdenum layer stacked thereover, a two-layer structure of a copper layer and a titanium nitride layer or a tantalum nitride layer stacked thereover, and a two-layer structure of a titanium nitride layer and a molybdenum layer. As a stacked structure of three layers, a stacked layer of a tungsten layer or a tungsten nitride layer, an alloy of aluminum and silicon or an alloy of aluminum and titanium, and a titanium nitride layer or a titanium layer is preferable. - The
gate insulating layer 402 is formed over thegate electrode layer 401. - The
gate insulating layer 402 can be formed to have a single layer of a silicon oxide layer, a silicon nitride layer, a silicon oxynitride layer, or a silicon nitride oxide layer or a stacked layer thereof by a plasma CVD method or a sputtering method. For example, a silicon oxynitride layer may be formed by a plasma CVD method using SiH4, oxygen, and nitrogen as a deposition gas. - Next, an oxide semiconductor film is formed over the
gate insulating layer 402. - Note that before the oxide semiconductor film is formed by a sputtering method, dust on a surface of the
gate insulating layer 402 is preferably removed by reverse sputtering in which an argon gas is introduced and plasma is generated. The reverse sputtering refers to a method in which, without application of a voltage to a target side, an RF power source is used for application of a voltage to a substrate side under an argon atmosphere and plasma is generated in the vicinity of the substrate to modify a surface. Note that instead of an argon atmosphere, a nitrogen atmosphere, a helium atmosphere, or the like may be used. Alternatively, an argon atmosphere to which oxygen, N2O, or the like is added may be used. Further alternatively, an argon atmosphere to which Cl2, CF4, or the like is added may be used. - The oxide semiconductor film is formed by a sputtering method with use of an In-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor target. Alternatively, the oxide semiconductor film can be formed by a sputtering method under a rare gas (typically, argon) atmosphere, an oxygen atmosphere, or an atmosphere of a rare gas (typically, argon) and oxygen.
- The
gate insulating layer 402 and the oxide semiconductor film may be formed successively without exposure to air. Successive film formation without exposure to air makes it possible to obtain an interface of stacked layers, which are not contaminated by atmospheric components or impurity elements floating in air, such as moisture or hydrocarbon. Therefore, variation in characteristics of the thin film transistor can be reduced. - The oxide semiconductor film is processed into an island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer 430 (a first oxide semiconductor layer) by a photolithography step (see
FIG. 6A ). - Heat treatment is performed on the oxide semiconductor layer under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure, and then, slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere (see
FIG. 6B ). By heat treatment performed on theoxide semiconductor layer 430 under such an atmosphere, impurities contained in theoxide semiconductor layer 430, such as hydrogen and moisture, can be removed. - Note that in heat treatment, it is preferable that moisture, hydrogen, and the like be not contained in nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon. Alternatively, it is preferable that nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon introduced into an apparatus for heat treatment have purity of 6N (99.9999%) or more, preferably, 7N (99.99999%) or more; that is, an impurity concentration is set to 1 ppm or lower, preferably, 0.1 ppm or lower.
- As heat treatment, an instantaneous heating method can be employed, such as a heating method using an electric furnace, a GRTA (gas rapid thermal anneal) method using a heated gas, or an LRTA (Lamp Rapid Thermal Anneal) method using lamp light.
- Here, a heating method using an
electric furnace 601 is described with reference toFIG. 14 as one mode of heat treatment of theoxide semiconductor layer 430. -
FIG. 14 is a schematic view of theelectric furnace 601.Heaters 603 are provided outside achamber 602, which heats thechamber 602. Inside thechamber 602, a susceptor 605 in which asubstrate 604 is mounted is provided. Thesubstrate 604 is transferred into/from thechamber 602. In addition, thechamber 602 is provided with a gas supply means 606 and an evacuation means 607. With the gas supply means 606, a gas is introduced into thechamber 602. The evacuation means 607 exhausts the inside of thechamber 602 or reduces the pressure in thechamber 602. Note that the temperature rising characteristics of the electric furnace is preferably set to from 0.1° C./min to 20° C./min. The temperature decreasing characteristics of the electric furnace is preferably set to from 0.1° C./min to 15° C./min. - The gas supply means 606 includes a
gas supply source 611, apressure adjusting valve 612, arefining apparatus 613, amass flow controller 614, and astop valve 615. In this embodiment, it is preferable that therefining apparatus 613 be provided between thegas supply source 611 and thechamber 602. Therefining apparatus 613 can remove impurities such as moisture and hydrogen in a gas which is introduced from thegas supply source 611 into thechamber 602; thus, entry into thechamber 602, of moisture, hydrogen, and the like, can be suppressed by provision of therefining apparatus 613. - In this embodiment, nitrogen or a rare gas is introduced into the
chamber 602 from thegas supply source 611, so that the inside of thechamber 602 is in a nitrogen or a rare gas atmosphere. In thechamber 602 heated at from 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably, from 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive, theoxide semiconductor layer 430 formed over thesubstrate 604 is heated, whereby theoxide semiconductor layer 430 can be dehydrated or dehydrogenated. - Alternatively, the
chamber 602 in which the pressure is reduced by the evacuation means is heated at from 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably, from 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive. In such achamber 602, theoxide semiconductor layer 430 formed over thesubstrate 604 is heated, whereby theoxide semiconductor layer 430 can be dehydrated or dehydrogenated. - Next, the heaters are turned off, and the
chamber 602 of the heating apparatus is gradually cooled. By performance of heat treatment and slow cooling under an inert-gas atmosphere or under reduced pressure, resistance of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1×1018/cm3 or higher), so that a low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 431 (a second oxide semiconductor layer) can be formed. - As a result, reliability of the thin film transistor formed later can be improved.
- Note that in the case where heat treatment is performed under reduced pressure, an inert gas may be discharged after the heat treatment, so that the chamber is to be under an atmospheric pressure, and then, cooling may be performed.
- After the
substrate 604 in thechamber 602 of the heating apparatus is cooled to 300° C., thesubstrate 604 may be transferred into an atmosphere at room temperature. As a result, the cooling time of thesubstrate 604 can be shortened. - If the heating apparatus has a multi-chamber structure, heat treatment and cool treatment can be performed in chambers different from each other. Typically, an oxide semiconductor layer over a substrate is heated in a first chamber which is filled with nitrogen or a rare gas and heated at from 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably from 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive. Next, the substrate subjected to heat treatment is transferred, through a transfer chamber in which nitrogen or a rare gas is introduced, into a second chamber which is filled with nitrogen or a rare gas and heated at 100° C. or lower, preferably at room temperature, and then cooling treatment is performed therein. Through the above steps, throughput can be increased.
- The heat treatment of the oxide semiconductor layer under an inert-gas atmosphere or reduced pressure may be performed on the oxide semiconductor film which has not yet been processed into the island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer. In that case, after heat treatment of the oxide semiconductor film performed under an inert-gas atmosphere or reduced pressure, slow cooling is performed to the temperature equal to or higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C. Then, the substrate is taken out from the heating apparatus, and a photolithography step is performed.
- The oxide semiconductor film which has been subjected to heat treatment under an inert-gas atmosphere or reduced pressure is preferably an amorphous film, but a part thereof may be crystallized.
- Next, a conductive film is formed over the
gate insulating layer 402 and theoxide semiconductor layer 431. - As a material for the conductive film, an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, Mo, and W; an alloy containing any of the above elements as its component; an alloy film containing a combination of any of the above elements; and the like can be given.
- If heat treatment is performed after formation of the conductive film, the conductive film preferably has heat resistance enough to withstand the heat treatment. Since use of Al alone brings disadvantages such as low resistance and a tendency to be corroded, aluminum is used in combination with a conductive material having heat resistance. As the conductive material having heat resistance which is used in combination with Al, any of the following materials may be used: an element selected from titanium (Ti), tantalum (Ta), tungsten (W), molybdenum (Mo), chromium (Cr), neodymium (Nd), and scandium (Sc), an alloy containing any of these above elements as a component, an alloy containing these elements in combination, and a nitride containing any of these above elements as a component.
- The
oxide semiconductor layer 431 and the conductive film are etched in an etching step, so that anoxide semiconductor layer 432 and the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b are formed (seeFIG. 6C ). Note that theoxide semiconductor layer 432 is partly etched so as to have a groove (a depressed portion). - The
oxide insulating film 407 is formed by a sputtering method so as to be in contact with theoxide semiconductor layer 432. Theoxide insulating film 407 which is formed to be in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer does not contain impurities such as moisture, a hydrogen ion, and OH− and is formed using an inorganic insulating film which prevents the impurities from entering from the outside. Specifically, a silicon oxide film or a silicon nitride oxide is used. - In this embodiment, as the
oxide insulating film 407, a 300-nm-thick silicon oxide film is formed. The substrate temperature in film formation may be from room temperature to 300° C. or lower and in this embodiment, is 100° C. The formation of the silicon oxide film by a sputtering method can be performed under a rare gas (typically, argon) atmosphere, an oxygen atmosphere, or an atmosphere of a rare gas (typically, argon) and oxygen. As a target, a silicon oxide target or a silicon target may be used. For example, with use of a silicon target, a silicon oxide film can be formed by a sputtering method under an atmosphere of oxygen and nitrogen. - When the
oxide insulating film 407 is formed by a sputtering method, a PCVD method, or the like to be in contact with the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 432, in the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 432, at least a region in contact with theoxide insulating film 407 have increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained. During a manufacture process of a semiconductor device, it is important to increase and decrease the carrier concentration in the oxide semiconductor layer through performance of heat treatment and slow cooling under an inert-gas atmosphere (or reduced pressure), formation of an oxide insulating film, and the like. Theoxide semiconductor layer 432 becomes thesemiconductor layer 403 having a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region (a third oxide semiconductor layer), and then, thethin film transistor 470 can be completed (seeFIG. 6D ). - Impurities (such as H2O, H, and OH) contained in the oxide semiconductor layer are reduced by performance of the heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, and the carrier concentration is increased. After that, slow cooling is performed. Then, formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer, or the like, is performed, so that the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced. Thus, reliability of the
thin film transistor 470 can be improved. - Further, after formation of the
oxide insulating film 407, heat treatment may be performed on thethin film transistor 470, under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air) at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably. For example, heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. is performed for one hour. In such heat treatment, theoxide semiconductor layer 432 in a condition of being in contact with theoxide insulating film 407 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of thethin film transistor 470 can be reduced. There is no particular limitation on when to perform this heat treatment (at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably) as long as it is performed after theoxide insulating film 407 is formed. When this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing. - A semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to
FIGS. 8A to 8D andFIGS. 9A and 9B . The same portion as or a portion having functions similar to those described inEmbodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described inEmbodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted. -
FIG. 9A is a top view of athin film transistor 460 included in a semiconductor device, andFIG. 9B is a cross-sectional view along line D1-D2 ofFIG. 9A . Thethin film transistor 460 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over asubstrate 450 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, agate electrode layer 451, agate insulating layer 452, source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b, and asemiconductor layer 453. In addition, anoxide insulating film 457 is provided so as to cover thethin film transistor 460 and be in contact with thesemiconductor layer 453. For thesemiconductor layer 453, an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is used. - In the
thin film transistor 460, thegate insulating layer 452 exists throughout the region including thethin film transistor 460, and thegate electrode layer 451 is provided between thegate insulating layer 452 and thesubstrate 450 which is a substrate having an insulating surface. Over thegate insulating layer 452, the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b are provided. Further, over thegate insulating layer 452 and the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b, thesemiconductor layer 453 is provided. Although not illustrated, in addition to the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b, a wiring layer is provided over thegate insulating layer 452, and the wiring layer extends beyond the peripheral portion of thesemiconductor layer 453. - The
semiconductor layer 453 formed using an oxide semiconductor film is subjected to heat treatment (heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation) for reducing impurities such as moisture and the like at least after formation of the oxide semiconductor film, so that resistance is reduced (the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1×1018/cm3 or higher). After that, theoxide insulating film 457 is formed to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor film, so that the oxide semiconductor film has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3). Accordingly, the oxide semiconductor film can be used as a channel formation region. - After elimination of impurities such as moisture (H2O) by performance of heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, it is preferable that slow cooling be performed in an inert atmosphere. After heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation and slow cooling, the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced by formation of an oxide insulating film to be in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer or the like, which improves reliability of the
thin film transistor 460. - The source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b in contact with the
semiconductor layer 453 which is an oxide semiconductor layer is formed using one or more materials selected from titanium, aluminum, manganese, magnesium, zirconium, and beryllium. -
FIGS. 8A to 8D are cross-sectional views illustrating manufacturing steps of thethin film transistor 460. - The
gate electrode layer 451 is provided over thesubstrate 450 which is a substrate having an insulating surface. An insulating film serving as a base film may be provided between thesubstrate 450 and thegate electrode layer 451. The base film has a function of preventing diffusion of an impurity element from thesubstrate 450, and can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using one or more of a silicon nitride film, a silicon oxide film, a silicon nitride oxide film, and a silicon oxynitride film. Thegate electrode layer 451 can be formed to have a single-layer or stacked-layer structure using a metal material selected from molybdenum, titanium, chromium, tantalum, tungsten, aluminum, copper, neodymium, and scandium, or an alloy material which contains any of these materials as its main component. - The
gate insulating layer 452 is formed over thegate electrode layer 451. - The
gate insulating layer 452 can be formed by a plasma CVD method or a sputtering method to have a single layer of a silicon oxide layer, a silicon nitride layer, a silicon oxynitride layer, or a silicon nitride oxide layer or a stacked layer thereof. - Over the
gate insulating layer 452, a conductive film is formed and patterned into island-shaped source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b by a photolithography step (FIG. 8A ). - As the material of the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b, there are an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, Mo, and W, an alloy including any of these elements as its component, an alloy including a combination of any of these elements, and the like. Further, an alloy film including these elements in combination, and the like, may be stacked.
- The source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b are preferably formed using a molybdenum film having high heat resistance enough to withstand heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation performed later. In addition, an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, and W, an alloy including any of the above elements, an alloy film including these elements in combination, and the like may be stacked over the molybdenum film.
- Then, an oxide semiconductor film is formed over the
gate insulating layer 452 and the source and drain electrode layers 455 a and 455 b, and patterned into an island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer 483 (a first oxide semiconductor layer) by a photolithography step (FIG. 8B ). - The
oxide semiconductor layer 483 serves as a channel formation region and is thus formed in a manner similar to the first oxide semiconductor film inEmbodiment 1. - Note that before the
oxide semiconductor layer 483 is formed by a sputtering method, dust attached to a surface of thegate insulating layer 452 is preferably removed by reverse sputtering in which an argon gas is introduced and plasma is generated. - Heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed on the
oxide semiconductor layer 483, and then, slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere. As heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, heat treatment is performed under an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) atmosphere or under reduced pressure at temperature of from 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably, from 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive. By the heat treatment in the above atmosphere, resistance of theoxide semiconductor layer 483 is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1×1018/cm3 or higher), so that a low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer 484 (a second oxide semiconductor layer) can be obtained (seeFIG. 8C ). - Note that in heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, it is preferable that moisture, hydrogen, and the like be not contained in nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon. Alternatively, it is preferable that nitrogen or a rare gas such as helium, neon, or argon introduced into an apparatus for heat treatment have purity of 6N (99.9999%) or more, preferably, 7N (99.99999%) or more; that is, an impurity concentration is set to 1 ppm or lower, preferably, 0.1 ppm or lower.
- The heat treatment of the oxide semiconductor layer under an inert-gas atmosphere or under reduced pressure may be performed on the oxide semiconductor film which has not yet been processed into the island-shaped oxide semiconductor layer. In that case, after heat treatment of the oxide semiconductor film performed under an inert-gas atmosphere or reduced pressure, slow cooling is performed to the temperature equal to or higher than room temperature and lower than 100° C. Then, the substrate is taken out from the heating apparatus, and a photolithography step is performed.
- Next, the
oxide insulating film 457 is formed by a sputtering method or a PCVD method to be in contact with theoxide semiconductor layer 484. In this embodiment, a 300-nm-thick silicon oxide film is formed as theoxide insulating film 457. The substrate temperature in film formation may be from room temperature to 300° C. or lower and in this embodiment, is 100° C. When theoxide insulating film 457 is formed by a sputtering method to be in contact with the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 484, in the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 484, at least a region in contact with theoxide insulating film 457 which is a silicon oxide film have increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained. During a manufacture process of a semiconductor device, it is important to increase and decrease the carrier concentration in the oxide semiconductor layer by performance of heat treatment and slow cooling under an inert-gas atmosphere (or under reduced pressure), formation of an oxide insulating film, and the like. Theoxide semiconductor layer 484 becomes thesemiconductor layer 453 having the high-resistance oxide semiconductor region (a third oxide semiconductor layer), and then, thethin film transistor 460 can be completed (seeFIG. 8D ). - Impurities (such as H2O, H, and OH) contained in the oxide semiconductor layer are reduced by performance of heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, and the carrier concentration is increased. After that, slow cooling is performed. Then, formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer, or the like, is performed, so that the carrier concentration of the oxide semiconductor layer is reduced. Thus, reliability of the
thin film transistor 460 can be improved. - Further, after formation of the silicon oxide film as the
oxide insulating film 457, heat treatment may be performed on thethin film transistor 460, under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air) at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably. For example, heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for one hour. In such heat treatment, thesemiconductor layer 453 in a condition being in contact with theoxide insulating film 457 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of thethin film transistor 460 can be reduced. There is no particular limitation on when to perform this heat treatment (at equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably) as long as it is performed after theoxide insulating film 457 is formed. When this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing. - This embodiment can be freely combined with
Embodiment 1. - A manufacturing process of a semiconductor device including a thin film transistor will be described with reference to
FIGS. 10A to 10D ,FIGS. 11A to 11C ,FIG. 12 , and FIGS. 13A1, 13A2, 13B1, and 13B2. - In
FIG. 10A , as asubstrate 100 having a light-transmitting property, a glass substrate of barium borosilicate glass, aluminoborosilicate glass, or the like can be used. - Next, a conductive layer is formed over an entire surface of the
substrate 100, and then a first photolithography step is performed. A resist mask is formed, and then an unnecessary portion is removed by etching, so that wirings and electrodes (a gate wiring including agate electrode layer 101, acapacitor wiring 108, and a first terminal 121) are formed. At this time, the etching is performed so that at least end portions of thegate electrode layer 101 have a tapered shape. - Each of the gate wiring including the
gate electrode layer 101, thecapacitor wiring 108, and thefirst terminal 121 at a terminal portion is preferably formed using a heat-resistant conductive material such as an element selected from titanium (Ti), tantalum (Ta), tungsten (W), molybdenum (Mo), chromium (Cr), neodymium (Nd), and scandium (Sc); an alloy containing any of these elements as its component; an alloy film containing a combination of any of these elements; or a nitride containing any of these elements as its component. - Next, a
gate insulating layer 102 is formed over the entire surface of thegate electrode layer 101. Thegate insulating layer 102 is formed to a thickness of 50 to 250 nm by a PCVD method, a sputtering method, or the like. - For example, as the
gate insulating layer 102, a silicon oxide film is formed to a thickness of 100 nm by a sputtering method. Needless to say, thegate insulating layer 102 is not necessarily formed using such a silicon oxide film and may be formed to have a single-layer structure or a stacked-layer structure using another insulating film: a silicon oxynitride film, a silicon nitride film, an aluminum oxide film, a tantalum oxide film, and the like. - Next, an oxide semiconductor film (an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film) is formed over the
gate insulating layer 102. It is effective to form the In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film without exposure to air after the plasma treatment because dust and moisture do not adhere to the interface between the gate insulating layer and the semiconductor film. Here, the oxide semiconductor film is formed under an argon atmosphere, an oxygen atmosphere, or an atmosphere including both argon and oxygen under the conditions where the target is an oxide semiconductor target including In, Ga, and Zn (an In-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor target (In2O3: Ga2O3: ZnO=1:1:1)) with a diameter of 8 inches, the distance between the substrate and the target is set to 170 mm, the pressure is set at 0.4 Pa, and the direct current (DC) power supply is set at 0.5 kW. Note that a pulse direct current (DC) power supply is preferable because dust can be reduced and the film thickness can be uniform. The second In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is formed to have a thickness of 5 nm to 200 nm. As the oxide semiconductor film, a 50-nm-thick In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is formed by a sputtering method using an In-Ga-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor target. - Examples of a sputtering method include an RF sputtering method in which a high-frequency power source is used as a sputtering power source, a DC sputtering method, and a pulsed DC sputtering method in which a bias is applied in a pulsed manner. An RF sputtering method is mainly used in the case where an insulating film is formed, and a DC sputtering method is mainly used in the case where a metal film is formed.
- In addition, there is a multi-source sputtering apparatus in which a plurality of targets of different materials can be set. With the multi-source sputtering apparatus, films of different materials can be formed to be stacked in the same chamber, or a film of plural kinds of materials can be deposited by electric discharge at the same time in the same chamber.
- In addition, there are a sputtering apparatus provided with a magnet system inside the chamber and used for a magnetron sputtering, and a sputtering apparatus used for an ECR sputtering in which plasma generated with the use of microwaves is used without using glow discharge.
- Furthermore, as a deposition method using sputtering, there are also a reactive sputtering method in which a target substance and a sputtering gas component are chemically reacted with each other during deposition to form a thin compound film thereof, and a bias sputtering in which a voltage is also applied to a substrate during deposition.
- Next, a second photolithography step is performed. A resist mask is formed, and then the oxide semiconductor film is etched. For example, unnecessary portions are removed by wet etching using a mixed solution of phosphoric acid, acetic acid, and nitric acid, so that an
oxide semiconductor layer 133 is formed (seeFIG. 10A ). Note that etching here is not limited to wet etching but dry etching may also be performed. - As the etching gas for dry etching, a gas containing chlorine (chlorine-based gas such as chlorine (Cl2), boron chloride (BCl3), silicon chloride (SiCl4), or carbon tetrachloride (CCl4)) is preferably used.
- Alternatively, a gas containing fluorine (fluorine-based gas such as carbon tetrafluoride (CF4), sulfur fluoride (SF6), nitrogen fluoride (NF3), or trifluoromethane (CHF3)); hydrogen bromide (HBr); oxygen (O2); any of these gases to which a rare gas such as helium (He) or argon (Ar) is added; or the like can be used.
- As the dry etching method, a parallel plate RIE (reactive ion etching) method or an ICP (inductively coupled plasma) etching method can be used. In order to etch the films into desired shapes, the etching condition (the amount of electric power applied to a coil-shaped electrode, the amount of electric power applied to an electrode on a substrate side, the temperature of the electrode on the substrate side, or the like) is adjusted as appropriate.
- As an etchant used for wet etching, a solution obtained by mixing phosphoric acid, acetic acid, and nitric acid, or the like can be used. In addition, ITO07N (produced by KANTO CHEMICAL CO., INC.) may also be used.
- The etchant used in the wet etching is removed by cleaning together with the material which is etched off. Waste liquid of the etchant containing the removed materials may be purified to recycle the materials contained in the waste liquid. When a material such as indium included in the oxide semiconductor layer is collected from the waste liquid after the etching and reused, the resources can be efficiently used and the cost can be reduced.
- The etching conditions (such as an etchant, etching time, and temperature) are appropriately adjusted depending on the material so that the material can be etched into a desired shape.
- Next, heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed on the
oxide semiconductor layer 133. After heat treatment performed under an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) atmosphere or under reduced pressure for theoxide semiconductor layer 133, slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere. - Heat treatment is preferably performed at a temperature of 200° C. or higher. For example, heat treatment is performed for 1 hour at 450° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. By the heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere, resistance of the
oxide semiconductor layer 133 is reduced (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1×1018/cm3 or higher), which results in increase of conductivity of theoxide semiconductor layer 133. Therefore, a low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 134 is formed (seeFIG. 10B ). Preferable electrical conductivity of theoxide semiconductor layer 134 is from 1×10−1 S/cm to 1×102 S/cm inclusive. - Next, a
conductive film 132 is formed using a metal material over theoxide semiconductor layer 134 by a sputtering method or a vacuum evaporation method (seeFIG. 10C ). - As the material of the
conductive film 132, an element selected from Al, Cr, Ta, Ti, Mo, and W, an alloy containing any of these elements as a component, an alloy film containing these elements in combination, and the like can be given. - When heat treatment is performed after the
conductive film 132 is formed, the conductive film preferably has heat resistance enough to withstand this heat resistance. - Next, a third photolithography step is performed. A resist mask is formed, and unnecessary portions are removed, so that source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b, and a
second terminal 122 are formed (seeFIG. 10D ). Wet etching or dry etching is employed as an etching method at this time. For example, when an aluminum film or an aluminum-alloy film is used as theconductive film 132, wet etching using a mixed solution of phosphoric acid, acetic acid, and nitric acid can be carried out. Here, by wet etching using an ammonia hydrogen peroxide mixture (with the ratio of hydrogen peroxide:ammonia:water =5:2:2), theconductive film 132 is etched to form the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b. In this etching step, an exposed region of theoxide semiconductor layer 134 is also partly etched to form asemiconductor layer 135. Thus, a region of thesemiconductor layer 135, which lies between the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b has a small thickness. InFIG. 10D , etching of the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b and thesemiconductor layer 135 are simultaneously conducted using dry etching; therefore, the end portions of the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b are aligned with the end portions of thesemiconductor layer 135, so that a continuous structure is provided. - In the third photolithography step, the
second terminal 122 which is formed from the same material as the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b is left in a terminal portion. Note that thesecond terminal 122 is electrically connected to a source wiring (a source wiring including the source or drain electrode layers 105 a or 105 b). - Further, by use of a resist mask having regions with plural thicknesses (typically, two different thicknesses) which is formed using a multi-tone mask, the number of resist masks can be reduced, resulting in simplified process and lower costs.
- Next, the resist mask is removed and a protective
insulating layer 107 is formed to cover thegate insulating layer 102, theoxide semiconductor layer 135, and the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b. The protectiveinsulating layer 107 is formed using a silicon oxynitride film by a PCVD method. When an exposed region of theoxide semiconductor layer 135 which lies between the source and drain electrode layers 105 a and 105 b is provided to be in contact with the oxynitride film that is the protective insulatinglayer 107, in theoxide semiconductor layer 135, a region in contact with the protective insulatinglayer 107 has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3). Thus, asemiconductor layer 103 having a high-resistance channel formation region can be formed (seeFIG. 11A ). - Heat treatment may be performed under an oxygen atmosphere before formation of the protective insulating
layer 107. The heat treatment under an oxygen atmosphere may be performed at a temperature higher than or equal to 150° C. and lower than 350° C. - Heat treatment may be performed after formation of the protective insulating
layer 107. The heat treatment may be performed under an air atmosphere or a nitrogen atmosphere at a temperature higher than or equal to 150° C. and lower than 350° C. In such heat treatment, thesemiconductor layer 103 in a condition being in contact with theoxide insulating layer 107 is heated, which leads to increase in resistance of thesemiconductor layer 103; thus, electric characteristics of the transistor can be improved and variation in electric characteristics can be reduced. There is no particular limitation on when to perform this heat treatment (at equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably) as long as it is performed after the protective insulatinglayer 107 is formed. When this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing. - Through the above steps, a
thin film transistor 170 can be completed. - Next, a fourth photolithography step is performed. A resist mask is formed, and the protective insulating
layer 107 and thegate insulating layer 102 are etched to form acontact hole 125 that reaches thedrain electrode layer 105 b. In addition, acontact hole 127 reaching thesecond terminal 122 and acontact hole 126 reaching thefirst terminal 121 are also formed in the same etching step. A cross-sectional view at this stage is illustrated inFIG. 11B . - Next, the resist mask is removed, and then a transparent conductive film is formed. The transparent conductive film is formed of indium oxide (In2O3), indium oxide-tin oxide alloy (In2O3—SnO2, abbreviated to ITO), or the like by a sputtering method, a vacuum evaporation method, or the like. Such a material is etched with a hydrochloric acid-based solution. However, since a residue is easily generated particularly in etching ITO, indium oxide-zinc oxide alloy (In2O3—ZnO) may be used to improve etching processability. Further, when heat treatment for reducing resistance of the transparent conductive film, the heat treatment can serve as heat treatment for increasing resistance of the
semiconductor layer 103, which results in improvement of electric characteristics of the transistor and reduction of variation in the electric characteristics thereof. - Next, a fifth photolithography step is performed. A resist mask is formed, and an unnecessary portion of the transparent conductive film is removed by etching to form a
pixel electrode layer 110. - In the fifth photolithography step, a storage capacitor is formed with the
capacitor wiring 108 and thepixel electrode layer 110, in which thegate insulating layer 102 and the protective insulatinglayer 107 in the capacitor portion are used as a dielectric. - In addition, in this fifth photolithography step, the
first terminal 121 and thesecond terminal 122 are covered with the resist mask, and transparentconductive films conductive films conductive film 128 formed over thefirst terminal 121 is a connecting terminal electrode serving as an input terminal of a gate wiring. The transparentconductive film 129 formed over thesecond terminal 122 is a connection terminal electrode which functions as an input terminal of the source wiring. - Then, the resist mask is removed. A cross-sectional view at this stage is illustrated in
FIG. 11C . Note that a plan view at this stage corresponds toFIG. 12 . - FIGS. 13A1 and 13A2 are respectively a cross-sectional view and a top view of a gate wiring terminal portion at this stage. FIG. 13A1 is a cross-sectional view taken along line C1-C2 of FIG. 13A2. In FIG. 13A1, a transparent
conductive film 155 formed over a protectiveinsulating layer 154 is a connection terminal electrode which functions as an input terminal. Furthermore, in the terminal portion of FIG. 13A1, afirst terminal 151 made of the same material as the gate wiring and aconnection electrode layer 153 made of the same material as the source wiring overlap each other with agate insulating layer 152 interposed therebetween, and are electrically connected to each other through the transparentconductive film 155. Note that a part ofFIG. 11C where the transparentconductive film 128 is in contact with thefirst terminal 121 corresponds to a part of FIG. 13A1 where the transparentconductive film 155 is in contact with thefirst terminal 151. - FIGS. 13B1 and 13B2 are respectively a cross-sectional view and a top view of a source wiring terminal portion which is different from that illustrated in
FIG. 11C . Moreover, FIG. 13B1 corresponds to a cross-sectional view taken along line F1-F2 of FIG. 13B2. In FIG. 13B1, a transparentconductive film 155 formed over a protectiveinsulating layer 154 is a connection terminal electrode which functions as an input terminal. Furthermore, in FIG. 13B1, in the terminal portion, anelectrode layer 156 formed from the same material as the gate wiring is located below and overlapped with asecond terminal 150, which is electrically connected to the source wiring, with agate insulating layer 152 interposed therebetween. Theelectrode layer 156 is not electrically connected to thesecond terminal 150, and a capacitor to prevent noise or static electricity can be formed if the potential of theelectrode layer 156 is set to a potential different from that of thesecond terminal 150, such as floating, GND, or 0 V. Thesecond terminal 150 is electrically connected to the transparentconductive film 155 through the protective insulatinglayer 154. - A plurality of gate wirings, source wirings, and capacitor wirings are provided depending on the pixel density. Also in the terminal portion, a plurality of first terminals at the same potential as the gate wiring, a plurality of second terminals at the same potential as the source wiring, a plurality of third terminals at the same potential as the capacitor wiring, and the like are arranged. The number of each of the terminals may be any number, and the number of the terminals may be determined by a practitioner as appropriate.
- Through these five photolithography steps, the storage capacitor and a pixel thin film transistor portion including the
thin film transistor 170 which is a bottom-gate staggered thin film transistor can be completed using the five photomasks. By disposing the thin film transistor and the storage capacitor in each pixel of a pixel portion in which pixels are arranged in a matrix form, one of substrates for manufacturing an active matrix display device can be obtained. In this specification, such a substrate is referred to as an active matrix substrate for convenience. - In the case of manufacturing an active matrix liquid crystal display device, an active matrix substrate and a counter substrate provided with a counter electrode are bonded to each other with a liquid crystal layer interposed therebetween. Note that a common electrode electrically connected to the counter electrode on the counter substrate is provided over the active matrix substrate, and a fourth terminal electrically connected to the common electrode is provided in the terminal portion. The fourth terminal is provided so that the common electrode is set to a fixed potential such as GND or 0 V.
- Instead of providing the capacitor wiring, the pixel electrode may be overlapped with a gate wiring of an adjacent pixel with the protective insulating layer and the gate insulating layer interposed therebetween, so that a storage capacitor is formed.
- In an active matrix liquid crystal display device, pixel electrodes arranged in a matrix form are driven to form a display pattern on a screen. Specifically, voltage is applied between a selected pixel electrode and a counter electrode corresponding to the pixel electrode, so that a liquid crystal layer provided between the pixel electrode and the counter electrode is optically modulated and this optical modulation is recognized as a display pattern by an observer.
- In displaying moving images, a liquid crystal display device has a problem that a long response time of liquid crystal molecules themselves causes afterimages or blurring of moving images. In order to improve the moving-image characteristics of a liquid crystal display device, a driving method called black insertion is employed in which black is displayed on the whole screen every other frame period.
- Alternatively, a driving method called double-frame rate driving may be employed in which a vertical synchronizing frequency is 1.5 times or more, preferably, 2 times or more as high as a usual vertical synchronizing frequency to improve the moving-image characteristics.
- Further alternatively, in order to improve the moving-image characteristics of a liquid crystal display device, a driving method may be employed, in which a plurality of LEDs (light-emitting diodes) or a plurality of EL light sources are used to form a surface light source as a backlight, and each light source of the surface light source is independently driven in a pulsed manner in one frame period. As the surface light source, three or more kinds of LEDs may be used and an LED emitting white light may be used. Since a plurality of LEDs can be controlled independently, the light emission timing of LEDs can be synchronized with the timing at which a liquid crystal layer is optically modulated. According to this driving method, LEDs can be partly turned off; therefore, an effect of reducing power consumption can be obtained particularly in the case of displaying an image having a large part on which black is displayed.
- By combining these driving methods, the display characteristics of a liquid crystal display device, such as moving-image characteristics, can be improved as compared to those of conventional liquid crystal display devices.
- The n-channel transistor disclosed in this specification includes an oxide semiconductor film which is used for a channel formation region and has excellent dynamic characteristics; thus, it can be combined with these driving techniques.
- In manufacturing a light-emitting display device, one electrode (also referred to as a cathode) of an organic light-emitting element is set to a low power supply potential such as GND or 0 V; thus, a terminal portion is provided with a fourth terminal for setting the cathode to a low power supply potential such as GND or 0 V. Also in manufacturing a light-emitting display device, a power supply line is provided in addition to a source wiring and a gate wiring. Accordingly, the terminal portion is provided with a fifth terminal electrically connected to the power supply line.
- When a light-emitting display device is manufactured, a partition formed using an organic resin layer may be provided between organic light-emitting elements in some cases. In such cases, the organic resin layer is subjected to heat treatment, and the heat treatment can serve as heat treatment for improvement of electric characteristics and reduction of variation in electric characteristics of the transistor by increasing resistance of the
semiconductor layer 103. - The use of an oxide semiconductor for a thin film transistor leads to reduction in manufacturing cost. In particular, since impurities such as moisture are reduced for increasing purity of the oxide semiconductor film by heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, it is not necessary to use a ultrapure oxide semiconductor target and a special sputtering apparatus provided with a deposition chamber whose dew point is lowered. Further, a semiconductor device including a highly reliable thin film transistor with excellent electric characteristics can be manufactured.
- The channel formation region in the semiconductor layer is a high-resistance region; thus, electric characteristics of the thin film transistor are stabilized and increase in off current can be prevented. Therefore, a semiconductor device including a thin film transistor having high electric characteristics and high reliability can be provided.
- This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- In this embodiment, an example of a display device which is one example of a semiconductor device will be described. In the display device, at least a part of a driver circuit and a thin film transistor to be disposed in a pixel portion are formed over one substrate.
- The thin film transistor in the pixel portion is formed according to any of
Embodiments 1 to 3. The thin film transistor described in any ofEmbodiments 1 to 3 is an n-channel TFT; therefore, part of a driver circuit which can be formed using an n-channel TFT is formed over the same substrate as the thin film transistor of the pixel portion. -
FIG. 20A illustrates an example of a block diagram of an active matrix liquid crystal display device, which is an example of a semiconductor device. The display device illustrated inFIG. 20A includes, over asubstrate 5300, apixel portion 5301 including a plurality of pixels each provided with a display element, a scanline driver circuit 5302 that selects a pixel, and a signalline driver circuit 5303 that controls a video signal input to a selected pixel. - The
pixel portion 5301 is connected to the signalline driver circuit 5303 by a plurality of signal lines S1 to Sm (not shown) which extend in a column direction from the signalline driver circuit 5303, and to the scanline driver circuit 5302 by a plurality of scan lines G1 to Gn (not shown) that extend in a row direction from the scanline driver circuit 5302. Then, each pixel is connected to a signal line Sj (any one of the signal lines S1 to Sm) and a scan line G1 (any one of the scan lines G1 to Gn). - In addition, the thin film transistor described in each of
Embodiments 1 to 3 is an n-channel TFT, and a signal line driver circuit including the n-channel TFT is described with reference toFIG. 21 . - The signal line driver circuit illustrated in
FIG. 21 includes adriver IC 5601, switch groups 5602_1 to 5602_M, afirst wiring 5611, asecond wiring 5612, athird wiring 5613, and wirings 5621_1 to 5621_M. Each of the switch groups 5602_1 to 5602_M includes a firstthin film transistor 5603 a, a secondthin film transistor 5603 b, and a thirdthin film transistor 5603 c. - The
driver IC 5601 is connected to thefirst wiring 5611, thesecond wiring 5612, thethird wiring 5613, and the wirings 5621_1 to 5621_M. Each of the switch groups 5602_1 to 5602_M is connected to thefirst wiring 5611, thesecond wiring 5612, and thethird wiring 5613, and the wirings 5621_1 to 5621_M are connected to the switch groups 5602_1 to 5602_M, respectively. Each of the wirings 5621_1 to 5621_M is connected to three signal lines via the firstthin film transistor 5603 a, the secondthin film transistor 5603 b, and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c. For example, the wiring 5621_J of the J-th column (one of the wirings 5621_1 to 5621_M) is connected to a signal line Sj−1, a signal line Sj, and a signal line Sj+1 via the firstthin film transistor 5603 a, the secondthin film transistor 5603 b, and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c which are included in the switch group 5602_J. - A signal is input to each of the
first wiring 5611, thesecond wiring 5612, and thethird wiring 5613. - Note that the
driver IC 5601 is preferably formed over a single crystalline substrate. Further, the switch groups 5602_1 to 5602_M are preferably formed over the same substrate as the pixel portion. Therefore, thedriver IC 5601 and the switch groups 5602_1 to 5602_M are preferably connected through an FPC or the like. - Next, the operation of the signal line driver circuit illustrated in
FIG. 21 is described with reference to a timing chart ofFIG. 22 .FIG. 22 illustrates the timing chart where a scan line Gi of the i-th row is selected. A selection period of the scan line Gi of the i-th row is divided into a first sub-selection period T1, a second sub-selection period T2, and a third sub-selection period T3. In addition, the signal line driver circuit inFIG. 21 operates similarly to that inFIG. 22 even when a scan line of another row is selected. - Note that the timing chart in
FIG. 22 shows the case where the wiring 5621_J of the J-th column is connected to the signal line Sj−1, the signal line Sj, and the signal line Sj+1 through the firstthin film transistor 5603 a, the secondthin film transistor 5603 b, and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c. - The timing chart of
FIG. 22 shows timing when the scan line Gi of the i-th row is selected, timing 5703 a when the firstthin film transistor 5603 a is turned on/off,timing 5703 b when the secondthin film transistor 5603 b is turned on/off,timing 5703 c when the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c is turned on/off, and a signal 5721_J input to the wiring 5621_J of the J-th column. - In the first sub-selection period T1, the second sub-selection period T2, and the third sub-selection period T3, different video signals are input to the wirings 5621_1 to 5621_M. For example, a video signal input to the wiring 5621_J in the first sub-selection period T1 is input to the signal line Sj−1, a video signal input to the wiring 5621_J in the second sub-selection period T2 is input to the signal line Sj, and a video signal input to the wiring 5621_J in the third sub-selection period T3 is input to the signal
line Sj+ 1. In addition, the video signals input to the wiring 5621_J in the first sub-selection period T1, the second sub-selection period T2, and the third sub-selection period T3 are denoted by Data_j−1, Data_j, and Data_j+1. - As shown in
FIG. 22 , in the first sub-selection period T1, the firstthin film transistor 5603 a is turned on, and the secondthin film transistor 5603 b and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c are turned off. At this time, Data_j−1 input to the wiring 5621_J is input to the signal line Sj−1 via the firstthin film transistor 5603 a. In the second sub-selection period T2, the secondthin film transistor 5603 b is turned on, and the firstthin film transistor 5603 a and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c are turned off. At this time, Data_j input to the wiring 5621_J is input to the signal line Sj via the secondthin film transistor 5603 b. In the third sub-selection period T3, the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c is turned on, and the firstthin film transistor 5603 a and the secondthin film transistor 5603 b are turned off. At this time, Data_j+1 input to the wiring 5621_J is input to the signal line Sj+1 via the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c. - As described above, in the signal line driver circuit in
FIG. 21 , by dividing one gate selection period into three, video signals can be input to three signal lines from one wiring 5621 in one gate selection period. Therefore, in the signal line driver circuit inFIG. 21 , the number of connections of the substrate provided with thedriver IC 5601 and the substrate provided with the pixel portion can be approximately ⅓ of the number of signal lines. The number of connections is decreased to approximately ⅓ of the number of the signal lines, so that reliability, yield, etc., of the signal line driver circuit inFIG. 21 can be improved. - Note that there are no particular limitations on the arrangement, the number, a driving method, and the like of the thin film transistors, as long as one gate selection period is divided into a plurality of sub-selection periods and video signals are input to a plurality of signal lines from one wiring in respective sub-selection periods as shown in
FIG. 21 . - For example, when video signals are input to three or more signal lines from one wiring in three or more sub-selection periods, it is only necessary to add a thin film transistor and a wiring for controlling the thin film transistor. Note that when one gate selection period is divided into four or more sub-selection periods, one sub-selection period becomes shorter. Therefore, one gate selection period is preferably divided into two or three sub-selection periods.
- As another example, as shown in a timing chart of
FIG. 23 , one selection period may be divided into a pre-charge period Tp, the first sub-selection period T1, the second sub-selection period T2, and the third sub-selection period T3. The timing chart inFIG. 23 shows timing at which the scan line Gi of the i-th row is selected, timing 5803 a of on/off of the firstthin transistor 5603 a,timing 5803 b of on/off of the secondthin transistor 5603 b,timing 5803 c of on/off of the thirdthin transistor 5603 c, and a signal 5821_J input to the wiring 5621_J of the J-th column. As shown inFIG. 23 , the firstthin film transistor 5603 a, the secondthin film transistor 5603 b, and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c are turned on in the pre-charge period Tp. At this time, pre-charge voltage Vp input to the wiring 5621_J is input to each of the signal line Sj−1, the signal line Sj, and the signal line Sj+1 via the firstthin film transistor 5603 a, the secondthin film transistor 5603 b, and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c. In the first sub-selection period T1, the firstthin film transistor 5603 a is turned on, and the secondthin film transistor 5603 b and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c are turned off. At this time, Data_j−1 input to the wiring 5621_J is input to the signal line Sj−1 via the firstthin film transistor 5603 a. In the second sub-selection period T2, the secondthin film transistor 5603 b is turned on, and the firstthin film transistor 5603 a and the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c are turned off. At this time, Data_j input to the wiring 5621_J is input to the signal line Sj via the secondthin film transistor 5603 b. In the third sub-selection period T3, the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c is turned on, and the firstthin film transistor 5603 a and the secondthin film transistor 5603 b are turned off. At this time, Data_j+1 input to the wiring 5621_J is input to the signal line Sj+1 via the thirdthin film transistor 5603 c. - As described above, in the signal line driver circuit of
FIG. 21 , to which the timing chart ofFIG. 23 is applied, the signal line can be pre-charged by providing the pre-charge period before the sub-selection periods. Thus, a video signal can be written to a pixel with high speed. Note that portions inFIG. 23 which are similar to those ofFIG. 22 are denoted by common reference numerals and detailed description of the same portions and portions which have similar functions is omitted. - Further, a structure of a scan line driver circuit is described. The scan line driver circuit includes a shift register. The scan line driver may be provided with a level shifter, a buffer, a switch, and the like as necessary, or may include only a shift register. In the scan line driver circuit, when the clock signal (CLK) and the start pulse signal (SP) are input to the shift register, a selection signal is generated. The generated selection signal is buffered and amplified by the buffer, and the resulting signal is supplied to a corresponding scan line. Gate electrodes of transistors in pixels of one line are connected to the scan line. Since the transistors in the pixels of one line have to be turned on all at once, a buffer which can supply a large current is used.
- One mode of a shift register used for a part of the scan line driver circuit will be described with reference to
FIG. 24 andFIG. 25 . -
FIG. 24 shows a circuit configuration of the shift register. The shift register shown inFIG. 24 includes a plurality of flip-flops: flip-flops 5701_1 to 5701_n. The shift register operates with input of a first clock signal, a second clock signal, a start pulse signal, and a reset signal. - Connection relations of the shift register in
FIG. 24 are described. In the flip-flop 5701_i (one of the flip-flops 5701_1 to 5701_n) of the i-th stage in the shift register ofFIG. 24 , afirst wiring 5501 shown inFIG. 25 is connected to a seventh wiring 5717_i−1; asecond wiring 5502 shown inFIG. 25 is connected to a seventhwiring 5717_i+ 1; athird wiring 5503 shown inFIG. 25 is connected to a seventh wiring 5717_i; and asixth wiring 5506 shown inFIG. 25 is connected to afifth wiring 5715. - Further, a
fourth wiring 5504 shown inFIG. 25 is connected to asecond wiring 5712 in flip-flops of odd-numbered stages, and is connected to athird wiring 5713 in flip-flops of even-numbered stages. Afifth wiring 5505 shown inFIG. 25 is connected to afourth wiring 5714. - Note that the
first wiring 5501 of the first stage flip-flop 5701_1 shown inFIG. 25 is connected to afirst wiring 5711. Moreover, thesecond wiring 5502 of the n-th stage flip-flop 5701_n shown inFIG. 25 is connected to asixth wiring 5716. - Note that the
first wiring 5711, thesecond wiring 5712, thethird wiring 5713, and thesixth wiring 5716 may be referred to as a first signal line, a second signal line, a third signal line, and a fourth signal line, respectively. Thefourth wiring 5714 and thefifth wiring 5715 may be referred to as a first power supply line and a second power supply line, respectively. - Next,
FIG. 25 shows details of the flip-flop shown inFIG. 24 . A flip-flop shown inFIG. 25 includes a firstthin film transistor 5571, a secondthin film transistor 5572, a thirdthin film transistor 5573, a fourththin film transistor 5574, a fifththin film transistor 5575, a sixththin film transistor 5576, a sevenththin film transistor 5577, and an eighththin film transistor 5578. Each of the firstthin film transistor 5571, the secondthin film transistor 5572, the thirdthin film transistor 5573, the fourththin film transistor 5574, the fifththin film transistor 5575, the sixththin film transistor 5576, the sevenththin film transistor 5577, and the eighththin film transistor 5578 is an n-channel transistor and is turned on when the gate-source voltage (Vgs) exceeds the threshold voltage (Vth). - Now a connection structure of the flip-flop shown in
FIG. 24 is described below. - A first electrode (one of a source electrode and a drain electrode) of the first
thin film transistor 5571 is connected to thefourth wiring 5504. A second electrode (the other of the source electrode and the drain electrode) of the firstthin film transistor 5571 is connected to thethird wiring 5503. - A first electrode of the second
thin film transistor 5572 is connected to thesixth wiring 5506. A second electrode of the secondthin film transistor 5572 is connected to thethird wiring 5503. - A first electrode of the third
thin film transistor 5573 is connected to thefifth wiring 5505, and a second electrode of the thirdthin film transistor 5573 is connected to a gate electrode of the secondthin film transistor 5572. A gate electrode of the thirdthin film transistor 5573 is connected to thefifth wiring 5505. - A first electrode of the fourth
thin film transistor 5574 is connected to thesixth wiring 5506. A second electrode of the fourththin film transistor 5574 is connected to a gate electrode of the secondthin film transistor 5572. A gate electrode of the fourththin film transistor 5574 is connected to a gate electrode of the firstthin film transistor 5571. - A first electrode of the fifth
thin film transistor 5575 is connected to thefifth wiring 5505. A second electrode of the fifththin film transistor 5575 is connected to the gate electrode of the firstthin film transistor 5571. A gate electrode of the fifththin film transistor 5575 is connected to thefirst wiring 5501. - A first electrode of the sixth
thin film transistor 5576 is connected to thesixth wiring 5506. A second electrode of the sixththin film transistor 5576 is connected to the gate electrode of the firstthin film transistor 5571. A gate electrode of the sixththin film transistor 5576 is connected to the gate electrode of the secondthin film transistor 5572. - A first electrode of the seventh
thin film transistor 5577 is connected to thesixth wiring 5506. A second electrode of the sevenththin film transistor 5577 is connected to the gate electrode of the firstthin film transistor 5571. A gate electrode of the sevenththin film transistor 5577 is connected to thesecond wiring 5502. A first electrode of the eighththin film transistor 5578 is connected to thesixth wiring 5506. A second electrode of the eighththin film transistor 5578 is connected to the gate electrode of the secondthin film transistor 5572. A gate electrode of the eighththin film transistor 5578 is connected to thefirst wiring 5501. - Note that the points at which the gate electrode of the first
thin film transistor 5571, the gate electrode of the fourththin film transistor 5574, the second electrode of the fifththin film transistor 5575, the second electrode of the sixththin film transistor 5576, and the second electrode of the sevenththin film transistor 5577 are connected are each referred to as anode 5543. The points at which the gate electrode of the secondthin film transistor 5572, the second electrode of the thirdthin film transistor 5573, the second electrode of the fourththin film transistor 5574, the gate electrode of the sixththin film transistor 5576, and the second electrode of the eighththin film transistor 5578 are connected are each referred to as anode 5544. - Note that the
first wiring 5501, thesecond wiring 5502, thethird wiring 5503, and thefourth wiring 5504 may be referred to as a first signal line, a second signal line, a third signal line, and a fourth signal line, respectively. Thefifth wiring 5505 and thesixth wiring 5506 may be referred to as a first power supply line and a second power supply line, respectively. - Moreover, the signal line driver circuit and the scan line driver circuit can be manufactured using only the n-channel TFTs described in any of
Embodiments 1 to 3. The n-channel TFT described in any one ofEmbodiments 1 to 3 has a high mobility, and thus a driving frequency of a driver circuit can be increased. Further, in the case of the n-channel TFT described in any ofEmbodiments 1 to 3, since parasitic capacitance is reduced, frequency characteristics (also referred to as f characteristics) are excellent. For example, a scan line driver circuit using the n-channel TFT described in any ofEmbodiments 1 to 3 can operate at high speed, and thus a frame frequency can be increased and insertion of black images and the like can be realized. - In addition, when the channel width of the transistor in the scan line driver circuit is increased or a plurality of scan line driver circuits are provided, for example, higher frame frequency can be realized. When a plurality of scan line driver circuits are provided, a scan line driver circuit for driving scan lines of even-numbered rows is provided on one side and a scan line driver circuit for driving scan lines of odd-numbered rows is provided on the opposite side; thus, an increase in frame frequency can be realized. Furthermore, the use of the plurality of scan line driver circuits for output of signals to the same scan line is advantageous in increasing the size of a display device.
- Further, when an active matrix light-emitting display device which is an example of a semiconductor device is manufactured, a plurality of thin film transistors are arranged in at least one pixel, and thus a plurality of scan line driver circuits are preferably arranged.
FIG. 20B illustrates an example of a block diagram of an active matrix light-emitting display device. - The display device illustrated in
FIG. 20B includes, over asubstrate 5400, apixel portion 5401 having a plurality of pixels each provided with a display element, a first scanline driver circuit 5402 and a second scanline driver circuit 5404 that select a pixel, and a signalline driver circuit 5403 that controls input of a video signal to the selected pixel. - When the video signal input to a pixel of the light-emitting display device illustrated in
FIG. 20B is a digital signal, a pixel is in a light-emitting state or in a non-light-emitting state by switching of ON/OFF of a transistor. Thus, grayscale can be displayed using an area grayscale method or a time grayscale method. An area grayscale method refers to a driving method in which one pixel is divided into a plurality of subpixels and the respective subpixels are driven independently based on video signals so that grayscale is displayed. Further, a time grayscale method refers to a driving method in which a period during which a pixel emits light is controlled so that grayscale is displayed. - Since the response time of a light-emitting element is higher than that of a liquid crystal element or the like, the light-emitting element is more suitable for a time grayscale method than the liquid crystal element. Specifically, in the case of displaying with a time grayscale method, one frame period is divided into a plurality of subframe periods. Then, in accordance with video signals, the light-emitting element in the pixel is brought into a light-emitting state or a non-light-emitting state in each subframe period. By dividing one frame period into a plurality of subframe periods, the total length of time, in which a pixel actually emits light in one frame period, can be controlled by video signals so that grayscale can be displayed.
- Note that in the light-emitting display device shown in
FIG. 20B , in the case where one pixel includes two switching TFTs, a signal which is input to a first scan line serving as a gate wiring of one of the switching TFTs is generated in the first scanline driver circuit 5402 and a signal which is input to a second scan line serving as a gate wiring of the other of the switching TFTs is generated in the second scanline driver circuit 5404. However, the signal which is input to the first scan line and the signal which is input to the second scan line may be generated together in one scan line driver circuit. In addition, for example, there is a possibility that a plurality of scan lines used for controlling the operation of the switching element are provided in each pixel, depending on the number of the switching TFTs included in one pixel. In this case, one scan line driver circuit may generate all signals that are input to the plurality of scan lines, or a plurality of scan line driver circuits may generate signals that are input to the plurality of scan lines. - Also in the light-emitting display device, a part of a driver circuit that can include n-channel TFTs among driver circuits can be formed over the same substrate as the thin film transistors of the pixel portion. Moreover, the signal line driver circuit and the scan line driver circuit can be manufactured using only the n-channel TFTs described in any of
Embodiments 1 to 3. - Moreover, the above-described driver circuit can be used for an electronic paper that drives electronic ink using an element electrically connected to a switching element, without being limited to applications to a liquid crystal display device or a light-emitting display device. The electronic paper is also referred to as an electrophoretic display device (an electrophoretic display) and is advantageous in that it has the same level of readability as plain paper, it has lower power consumption than other display devices, and it can be made thin and lightweight.
- Electrophoretic displays can have various modes. Electrophoretic displays contain a plurality of microcapsules dispersed in a solvent or a solute, each microcapsule containing first particles which are positively charged and second particles which are negatively charged. By applying an electric field to the microcapsules, the particles in the microcapsules move in opposite directions to each other and only the color of the particles gathering on one side is displayed. Note that the first particles and the second particles each contain pigment and do not move without an electric field. Moreover, the first particles and the second particles have different colors (which may be colorless).
- Thus, an electrophoretic display is a display that utilizes a so-called dielectrophoretic effect by which a substance having a high dielectric constant moves to a high-electric field region. The electrophoretic display does not require a polarizing plate which is necessary for a liquid crystal display device, so that the weight thereof is reduced.
- A solution in which the above microcapsules are dispersed in a solvent is referred to as electronic ink. This electronic ink can be printed on a surface of glass, plastic, cloth, paper, or the like. Furthermore, by using a color filter or particles that have a pigment, color display can also be achieved.
- In addition, if a plurality of the above microcapsules are arranged as appropriate over an active matrix substrate so as to be interposed between two electrodes, an active matrix display device can be completed, and display can be performed by application of an electric field to the microcapsules. For example, the active matrix substrate obtained using the thin film transistor of any of
Embodiments 1 to 3 can be used. - Note that the first particles and the second particles in the microcapsules may each be formed of a single material selected from a conductive material, an insulating material, a semiconductor material, a magnetic material, a liquid crystal material, a ferroelectric material, an electroluminescent material, an electrochromic material, and a magnetophoretic material, or formed of a composite material of any of these.
- Through the above process, a highly reliable display device as a semiconductor device can be manufactured.
- This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- A thin film transistor is manufactured, and a semiconductor device having a display function (also referred to as a display device) can be manufactured using the thin film transistor in a pixel portion and further in a driver circuit. Further, part or whole of the driver circuit can be formed over the same substrate as a pixel portion, using a thin film transistor, whereby a system-on-panel can be obtained.
- The display device includes a display element. As the display element, a liquid crystal element (also referred to as a liquid crystal display element) or a light-emitting element (also referred to as a light-emitting display element) can be used. The light-emitting element includes, in its category, an element whose luminance is controlled by the current or the voltage, and specifically includes, in its category, an inorganic electroluminescent (EL) element, an organic EL element, and the like. Furthermore, a display medium whose contrast is changed by an electric effect, such as electronic ink, can be used.
- In addition, the display device includes a panel in which the display element is sealed, and a module in which an IC or the like including a controller is mounted on the panel. Furthermore, an element substrate, which corresponds to one embodiment before the display element is completed in a manufacturing process of the display device, is provided with a means for supplying current to the display element in each of a plurality of pixels. Specifically, the element substrate may be in a state provided with only a pixel electrode of the display element, a state after a conductive film serving as a pixel electrode is formed and before the conductive film is etched to form the pixel electrode, or any of other states.
- Note that a display device in this specification means an image display device, a display device, or a light source (including a lighting device). Further, the “display device” includes the following modules in its category: a module including a connector such as a flexible printed circuit (FPC), a tape automated bonding (TAB) tape, or a tape carrier package (TCP) attached; a module having a TAB tape or a TCP which is provided with a printed wiring board at the end thereof; and a module having an integrated circuit (IC) which is directly mounted on a display element by a chip on glass (COG) method.
- The appearance and a cross section of a liquid crystal display panel, which is one embodiment of a semiconductor device, will be described with reference to FIGS. 16A1, 16A2, and 16B. FIGS. 16A1 and 16A2 are each a plan view of a panel in which highly reliable
thin film transistors Embodiment 3 and aliquid crystal element 4013 are sealed between afirst substrate 4001 and asecond substrate 4006 with asealant 4005.FIG. 16B is a cross-sectional view along line M-N in FIGS. 16A1 and 16A2. - The
sealant 4005 is provided so as to surround apixel portion 4002 and a scanline driver circuit 4004 which are provided over thefirst substrate 4001. Thesecond substrate 4006 is provided over thepixel portion 4002 and the scanline driver circuit 4004. Therefore, thepixel portion 4002 and the scanline driver circuit 4004 are sealed together with aliquid crystal layer 4008, by thefirst substrate 4001, thesealant 4005, and thesecond substrate 4006. A signalline driver circuit 4003 that is formed using a single crystal semiconductor film or a polycrystalline semiconductor film over a substrate separately prepared is mounted in a region that is different from the region surrounded by thesealant 4005 over thefirst substrate 4001. - Note that the connection method of a driver circuit which is separately formed is not particularly limited, and a COG method, a wire bonding method, a TAB method, or the like can be used. FIG. 16A1 illustrates an example of mounting the signal
line driver circuit 4003 by a COG method, and FIG. 16A2 illustrates an example of mounting the signalline driver circuit 4003 by a TAB method. - The
pixel portion 4002 and the scanline driver circuit 4004 provided over thefirst substrate 4001 include a plurality of thin film transistors.FIG. 16B illustrates thethin film transistor 4010 included in thepixel portion 4002 and thethin film transistor 4011 included in the scanline driver circuit 4004. Over thethin film transistors layers - Any of the highly reliable thin film transistors including the oxide semiconductor layer described in
Embodiment 3, can be used as thethin film transistors Embodiment thin film transistors - A
pixel electrode layer 4030 included in theliquid crystal element 4013 is electrically connected to thethin film transistor 4010. Acounter electrode layer 4031 of theliquid crystal element 4013 is provided for thesecond substrate 4006. A portion where thepixel electrode layer 4030, thecounter electrode layer 4031, and theliquid crystal layer 4008 overlap with one another corresponds to theliquid crystal element 4013. Note that thepixel electrode layer 4030 and thecounter electrode layer 4031 are provided with an insulatinglayer 4032 and an insulatinglayer 4033 respectively which each function as an alignment film, and theliquid crystal layer 4008 is sandwiched between thepixel electrode layer 4030 and thecounter electrode layer 4031 with the insulatinglayers - Note that the
first substrate 4001 and thesecond substrate 4006 can be formed of glass, metal (typically, stainless steel), ceramic, or plastic. As plastic, a fiberglass-reinforced plastics (FRP) plate, a polyvinyl fluoride (PVF) film, a polyester film, or an acrylic resin film can be used. In addition, a sheet with a structure in which an aluminum foil is sandwiched between PVF films or polyester films can be used. -
Reference numeral 4035 denotes a columnar spacer obtained by selectively etching an insulating film and is provided to control the distance between thepixel electrode layer 4030 and the counter electrode layer 4031 (a cell gap). Alternatively, a spherical spacer may also be used. In addition, thecounter electrode layer 4031 is electrically connected to a common potential line formed over the same substrate as thethin film transistor 4010. With use of the common connection portion, thecounter electrode layer 4031 and the common potential line can be electrically connected to each other by conductive particles arranged between a pair of substrates. Note that the conductive particles are included in thesealant 4005. - Alternatively, liquid crystal exhibiting a blue phase for which an alignment film is unnecessary may be used. A blue phase is one of liquid crystal phases, which is generated just before a cholesteric phase changes into an isotropic phase while temperature of cholesteric liquid crystal is increased. Since the blue phase is generated within an only narrow range of temperature, liquid crystal composition containing a chiral agent at 5 wt % or more so as to improve the temperature range is used for the
liquid crystal layer 4008. The liquid crystal composition which includes liquid crystal exhibiting a blue phase and a chiral agent have such characteristics that the response time is 1 msec or less, which is short, the alignment process is unnecessary because the liquid crystal composition has optical isotropy, and viewing angle dependency is small. - An embodiment of the present invention can also be applied to a reflective liquid crystal display device or a semi-transmissive liquid crystal display device, in addition to a transmissive liquid crystal display device.
- An example of the liquid crystal display device is described in which a polarizing plate is provided on the outer surface of the substrate (on the viewer side) and a coloring layer and an electrode layer used for a display element are provided on the inner surface of the substrate; however, the polarizing plate may be provided on the inner surface of the substrate. The stacked structure of the polarizing plate and the coloring layer is not limited to this embodiment and may be set as appropriate depending on materials of the polarizing plate and the coloring layer or conditions of manufacturing process. Further, a light-blocking film serving as a black matrix may be provided.
- In order to reduce surface unevenness of the thin film transistor and to improve reliability of the thin film transistor, the thin film transistor obtained in any of the above embodiments is covered with the insulating layers (the insulating
layer 4020 and the insulating layer 4021) functioning as a protective film or a planarizing insulating film. Note that the protective film is provided to prevent entry of contaminant impurities such as organic substance, metal, or moisture existing in air and is preferably a dense film. The protective film may be formed with a single layer or a stacked layer of a silicon oxide film, a silicon nitride film, a silicon oxynitride film, a silicon nitride oxide film, an aluminum oxide film, an aluminum nitride film, an aluminum oxynitride film, and/or an aluminum nitride oxide film by a sputtering method. Although an example in which the protective film is formed by a sputtering method is described in this embodiment, an embodiment of the present invention is not limited to this method and a variety of methods may be employed. - In this embodiment, the insulating
layer 4020 having a stacked-layer structure is formed as a protective film. Here, as a first layer of the insulatinglayer 4020, a silicon oxide film is formed by a sputtering method. The use of a silicon oxide film as a protective film has an effect of preventing hillock of an aluminum film used for the source and drain electrode layers. - As a second layer of the protective film, an insulating layer is formed. In this embodiment, as a second layer of the insulating
layer 4020, a silicon nitride film is formed by a sputtering method. The use of the silicon nitride film as the protective film can prevent mobile ions such as sodium ions from entering a semiconductor region, thereby suppressing variations in electrical properties of the TFT. - In addition, after the protective film is formed, heat treatment (at 300° C. or lower) may be performed under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere.
- The insulating
layer 4021 is formed as the planarizing insulating film. As the insulatinglayer 4021, an organic material having heat resistance such as polyimide, acrylic, benzocyclobutene, polyamide, or epoxy can be used. Other than such organic materials, it is also possible to use a low-dielectric constant material (a low-k material), a siloxane-based resin, PSG (phosphosilicate glass), BPSG (borophosphosilicate glass), or the like. Note that the insulatinglayer 4021 may be formed by stacking a plurality of insulating films formed of these materials. - Note that the siloxane-based resin corresponds to a resin including a Si—O—Si bond formed using a siloxane-based material as a starting material. The siloxane-based resin may include as a substituent an organic group (e.g., an alkyl group or an aryl group) or a fluoro group. In addition, the organic group may include a fluoro group.
- A formation method of the insulating
layer 4021 is not particularly limited, and the following method can be employed depending on the material: a sputtering method, an SOG method, a spin coating method, a dipping method, a spray coating method, a droplet discharge method (e.g., an ink-jet method, screen printing, offset printing, or the like), or the like. Further, the insulatinglayer 4021 can be formed with a doctor knife, a roll coater, a curtain coater, a knife coater, or the like. The baking step of the insulatinglayer 4021 also serves as annealing of the semiconductor layer, whereby a semiconductor device can be manufactured efficiently. - The
pixel electrode layer 4030 and thecounter electrode layer 4031 can be formed using a light-transmitting conductive material such as indium oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium zinc oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide (hereinafter referred to as ITO), indium zinc oxide, indium tin oxide to which silicon oxide is added, or the like. - Conductive compositions including a conductive high molecule (also referred to as a conductive polymer) can be used for the
pixel electrode layer 4030 and thecounter electrode layer 4031. The pixel electrode formed using the conductive composition preferably has a sheet resistance of less than or equal to 10000 ohms per square and a transmittance of greater than or equal to 70% at a wavelength of 550 nm. Further, the resistivity of the conductive high molecule included in the conductive composition is preferably less than or equal to 0.1 Ω·cm. - As the conductive high molecule, a so-called π-electron conjugated conductive polymer can be used. For example, polyaniline or a derivative thereof, polypyrrole or a derivative thereof, polythiophene or a derivative thereof, a copolymer of two or more kinds of them, and the like can be given.
- Further, a variety of signals and potentials are supplied to the signal
line driver circuit 4003 which is formed separately, the scanline driver circuit 4004, or thepixel portion 4002 from anFPC 4018. - A
connection terminal electrode 4015 is formed using the same conductive film as thepixel electrode layer 4030 included in theliquid crystal element 4013. Aterminal electrode 4016 is formed using the same conductive film as the source and drain electrode layers included in thethin film transistors - The
connection terminal electrode 4015 is electrically connected to a terminal included in theFPC 4018 via an anisotropicconductive film 4019. - Note that FIGS. 16A1, 16A2, and 16B illustrate an example in which the signal
line driver circuit 4003 is formed separately and mounted on thefirst substrate 4001; however, the present invention is not limited to this structure. The scan line driver circuit may be separately formed and then mounted, or only part of the signal line driver circuit or part of the scan line driver circuit may be separately formed and then mounted. -
FIG. 26 illustrates an example in which a liquid crystal display module is formed as a semiconductor device using aTFT substrate 2600 which is manufactured according to the manufacturing method disclosed in this specification. -
FIG. 26 illustrates an example of a liquid crystal display module, in which theTFT substrate 2600 and acounter substrate 2601 are fixed to each other with asealant 2602, and apixel portion 2603 including TFTs and the like, adisplay element 2604 including a liquid crystal layer, and acoloring layer 2605, are provided between the substrates to form a display region. Thecoloring layer 2605 is necessary to perform color display. In the RGB system, respective coloring layers corresponding to colors of red, green, and blue are provided for respective pixels. Polarizingplates diffusion plate 2613 are provided outside theTFT substrate 2600 and thecounter substrate 2601. A light source includes acold cathode tube 2610 and areflective plate 2611, and acircuit board 2612 is connected to awiring circuit portion 2608 of theTFT substrate 2600 by aflexible wiring board 2609 and includes an external circuit such as a control circuit or a power source circuit. The polarizing plate and the liquid crystal layer may be stacked with a retardation plate therebetween. - The liquid crystal display module can employ a TN (Twisted Nematic) mode, an IPS (In-Plane-Switching) mode, an FFS (Fringe Field Switching) mode, an MVA (Multi-domain Vertical Alignment) mode, a PVA (Patterned Vertical Alignment) mode, an ASM (Axially Symmetric aligned Micro-cell) mode, an OCB (Optical Compensated Birefringence) mode, an FLC (Ferroelectric Liquid Crystal) mode, an AFLC (Anti Ferroelectric Liquid Crystal) mode, or the like.
- Through the above process, a highly reliable liquid crystal display panel as a semiconductor device can be manufactured.
- This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- An example of an electronic paper will be described as a semiconductor device.
- The semiconductor device can be used for electronic paper in which electronic ink is driven by an element electrically connected to a switching element.
- The electronic paper is also referred to as an electrophoretic display device (an electrophoretic display) and is advantageous in that it has the same level of readability as plain paper, it has lower power consumption than other display devices, and it can be made thin and lightweight.
- Electrophoretic displays can have various modes. Electrophoretic displays contain a plurality of microcapsules dispersed in a solvent or a solute, each microcapsule containing first particles which are positively charged and second particles which are negatively charged. By applying an electric field to the microcapsules, the particles in the microcapsules move in opposite directions to each other and only the color of the particles gathering on one side is displayed. Note that the first particles and the second particles each contain pigment and do not move without an electric field. Moreover, the first particles and the second particles have different colors (which may be colorless).
- Thus, an electrophoretic display is a display that utilizes a so-called dielectrophoretic effect by which a substance having a high dielectric constant moves to a high-electric field region.
- A solution in which the above microcapsules are dispersed in a solvent is referred to as electronic ink. This electronic ink can be printed on a surface of glass, plastic, cloth, paper, or the like. Furthermore, by using a color filter or particles that have a pigment, color display can also be achieved.
- In addition, if a plurality of the above microcapsules are arranged as appropriate over an active matrix substrate so as to be interposed between two electrodes, an active matrix display device can be completed, and display can be performed by application of an electric field to the microcapsules. For example, the active matrix substrate obtained using the thin film transistor of any of
Embodiments 1 to 3 can be used. - Note that the first particles and the second particles in the microcapsules may each be formed of a single material selected from a conductive material, an insulating material, a semiconductor material, a magnetic material, a liquid crystal material, a ferroelectric material, an electroluminescent material, an electrochromic material, and a magnetophoretic material, or formed of a composite material of any of these.
-
FIG. 15 illustrates an active matrix electronic paper as an example of a semiconductor device. Athin film transistor 581 used for the semiconductor device can be formed in a manner similar to the thin film transistor described inEmbodiment 1, which is a highly reliable thin film transistor including an oxide semiconductor layer. Any of the thin film transistors described inEmbodiment thin film transistor 581 of this embodiment. - The electronic paper in
FIG. 15 is an example of a display device using a twisting ball display system. The twisting ball display system refers to a method in which spherical particles each colored in black and white are arranged between a first electrode layer and a second electrode layer which are electrode layers used for a display element, and a potential difference is generated between the first electrode layer and the second electrode layer to control orientation of the spherical particles, so that display is performed. - The
thin film transistor 581 has a bottom-gate structure, which is covered with an insulatingfilm 583 in contact with the semiconductor layer. A source electrode layer or a drain electrode layer of thethin film transistor 581 is in contact with afirst electrode layer 587 at an opening formed in the insulatingfilm 583 and an insulatinglayer 585, whereby thethin film transistor 581 is electrically connected to thefirst electrode layer 587. Between thefirst electrode layer 587 and asecond electrode layer 588,spherical particles 589 are provided. Eachspherical particle 589 includes ablack region 590 a and awhite region 590 b, and acavity 594 filled with liquid around theblack region 590 a and thewhite region 590 b. The circumference of thespherical particle 589 is filled withfiller 595 such as a resin (seeFIG. 15 ). In this embodiment, thefirst electrode layer 587 corresponds to a pixel electrode, and thesecond electrode layer 588, a common electrode. Thesecond electrode layer 588 is electrically connected to a common potential line provided over thesame substrate 580 as thethin film transistor 581. With the use of a common connection portion, thesecond electrode layer 588 can be electrically connected to the common potential line via conductive particles provided between the pair ofsubstrates - Further, instead of the twisting ball, an electrophoretic element can also be used. A microcapsule having a diameter of about 10 μm to 200 μm in which transparent liquid, positively charged white microparticles, and negatively charged black microparticles are encapsulated, is used. In the microcapsule which is provided between the first electrode layer and the second electrode layer, when an electric field is applied by the first electrode layer and the second electrode layer, the white microparticles and the black microparticles move to opposite sides, so that white or black can be displayed. A display element using this principle is an electrophoretic display element and is called electronic paper in general. The electrophoretic display element has higher reflectance than a liquid crystal display element, and thus, an auxiliary light is unnecessary, power consumption is low, and a display portion can be recognized in a dim place. In addition, even when power is not supplied to the display portion, an image which has been displayed once can be maintained. Accordingly, a displayed image can be stored even if a semiconductor device having a display function (which may be referred to simply as a display device or a semiconductor device provided with a display device) is distanced from an electric wave source.
- Through this process, a highly reliable electronic paper as a semiconductor device can be manufactured.
- This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- An example of a light-emitting display device will be described as a semiconductor device. As a display element included in a display device, a light-emitting element utilizing electroluminescence is described here. Light-emitting elements utilizing electroluminescence are classified according to whether a light-emitting material is an organic compound or an inorganic compound. In general, the former is referred to as an organic EL element, and the latter is referred to as an inorganic EL element.
- In an organic EL element, by application of voltage to a light-emitting element, electrons and holes are separately injected from a pair of electrodes into a layer containing a light-emitting organic compound, and current flows. The carriers (electrons and holes) are recombined, and thus, the light-emitting organic compound is excited. The light-emitting organic compound returns to a ground state from the excited state, thereby emitting light. Owing to such a mechanism, this light-emitting element is referred to as a current-excitation light-emitting element.
- The inorganic EL elements are classified according to their element structures into a dispersion-type inorganic EL element and a thin-film inorganic EL element. A dispersion-type inorganic EL element has a light-emitting layer where particles of a light-emitting material are dispersed in a binder, and its light emission mechanism is donor-acceptor recombination type light emission that utilizes a donor level and an acceptor level. A thin-film inorganic EL element has a structure where a light-emitting layer is sandwiched between dielectric layers, which are further sandwiched between electrodes, and its light emission mechanism is localized type light emission that utilizes inner-shell electron transition of metal ions. Note that an example of an organic EL element as a light-emitting element is described here.
-
FIG. 18 illustrates an example of a pixel structure to which digital time grayscale driving can be applied, as an example of a semiconductor device. - A structure and operation of a pixel to which digital time grayscale driving can be applied are described. Here, one pixel includes two n-channel transistors each of which includes an oxide semiconductor layer as a channel formation region.
- A
pixel 6400 includes aswitching transistor 6401, adriver transistor 6402, a light-emittingelement 6404, and acapacitor 6403. A gate of theswitching transistor 6401 is connected to ascan line 6406, a first electrode (one of a source electrode and a drain electrode) of theswitching transistor 6401 is connected to asignal line 6405, and a second electrode (the other of the source electrode and the drain electrode) of theswitching transistor 6401 is connected to a gate of thedriver transistor 6402. The gate of thedriver transistor 6402 is connected to apower supply line 6407 via thecapacitor 6403, a first electrode of thedriver transistor 6402 is connected to thepower supply line 6407, and a second electrode of thedriver transistor 6402 is connected to a first electrode (pixel electrode) of the light-emittingelement 6404. A second electrode of the light-emittingelement 6404 corresponds to acommon electrode 6408. Thecommon electrode 6408 is electrically connected to a common potential line provided over the same substrate. - The second electrode (common electrode 6408) of the light-emitting
element 6404 is set to a low power supply potential. Note that the low power supply potential is a potential satisfying that the low power supply potential is lower than a high power supply potential (low power supply potential <high power supply potential) based on the high power supply potential that is set to thepower supply line 6407. As the low power supply potential, GND, 0 V, or the like may be employed, for example. A potential difference between the high power supply potential and the low power supply potential is applied to the light-emittingelement 6404 and current is supplied to the light-emittingelement 6404, so that the light-emittingelement 6404 emits light. Here, in order to make the light-emittingelement 6404 emit light, each potential is set so that the potential difference between the high power supply potential and the low power supply potential is a forward threshold voltage or higher of the light-emittingelement 6404. - Note that the gate capacitor of the
driver transistor 6402 may be used as a substitute for thecapacitor 6403, so that thecapacitor 6403 can be omitted. The gate capacitance of thedriver transistor 6402 may be formed between the channel region and the gate electrode. - In the case of a voltage-input voltage driving method, a video signal is input to the gate of the
driver transistor 6402 so that thedriver transistor 6402 is in either of two states of being sufficiently turned on or turned off. That is, thedriver transistor 6402 operates in a linear region. Since thedriver transistor 6402 operates in the linear region, a voltage higher than the voltage of thepower supply line 6407 is applied to the gate of thedriver transistor 6402. Note that a voltage higher than or equal to the sum voltage of the power supply line voltage and Vth of the driver transistor 6402 (voltage of the power supply line+Vth of the driver transistor 6402) is applied to thesignal line 6405. - In a case of performing analog grayscale driving instead of digital time grayscale driving, the same pixel structure as that in
FIG. 18 can be used by changing signal input. - In the case of performing analog grayscale driving, a voltage higher than or equal to the sum voltage of the light-emitting
element 6404 and Vth of the driver transistor 6402 (forward voltage of the light-emittingelement 6404+Vth of the driver transistor 6402) is applied to the gate of thedriver transistor 6402. The forward voltage of the light-emittingelement 6404 indicates a voltage at which a desired luminance is obtained, and includes at least forward threshold voltage. The video signal by which thedriver transistor 6402 operates in a saturation region is input, so that current can be supplied to the light-emittingelement 6404. In order for thedriver transistor 6402 to operate in the saturation region, the potential of thepower supply line 6407 is set higher than the gate potential of thedriver transistor 6402. When an analog video signal is used, it is possible to feed current to the light-emittingelement 6404 in accordance with the video signal and perform analog grayscale driving. - Note that the pixel structure illustrated in
FIG. 18 is not limited thereto. For example, a switch, a resistor, a capacitor, a transistor, a logic circuit, or the like may be added to the pixel illustrated inFIG. 18 . - Next, structures of the light-emitting element will be described with reference to
FIGS. 19A to 19C . Here, a cross-sectional structure of a pixel will be described by taking an n-channel driving TFT as an example. DrivingTFTs FIGS. 19A, 19B, and 19C , respectively can be formed in a manner similar to the thin film transistor described inEmbodiment 1 and are highly reliable thin film transistors each including an oxide semiconductor layer. Alternatively, the thin film transistor described inEmbodiment TFTs - In order to extract light emitted from the light-emitting element, at least one of an anode and a cathode is required to transmit light. A thin film transistor and a light-emitting element are formed over a substrate. A light-emitting element can have a top emission structure, in which light emission is extracted through the surface opposite to the substrate; a bottom emission structure, in which light emission is extracted through the surface on the substrate side; or a dual emission structure, in which light emission is extracted through the surface opposite to the substrate and the surface on the substrate side. The pixel structure can be applied to a light-emitting element having any of these emission structures.
- A light-emitting element having a top emission structure will be described with reference to
FIG. 19A . -
FIG. 19A is a cross-sectional view of a pixel in the case where the drivingTFT 7001 is an n-channel TFT and light is emitted from a light-emittingelement 7002 to ananode 7005 side. InFIG. 19A , acathode 7003 of the light-emittingelement 7002 is electrically connected to the drivingTFT 7001, and a light-emittinglayer 7004 and theanode 7005 are stacked in this order over thecathode 7003. Thecathode 7003 can be formed using a variety of conductive materials as long as they have a low work function and reflect light. For example, Ca, Al, MgAg, AlLi, or the like is desirably used. The light-emittinglayer 7004 may be formed using a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked. When the light-emittinglayer 7004 is formed using a plurality of layers, the light-emittinglayer 7004 is formed by stacking an electron-injection layer, an electron-transport layer, a light-emitting layer, a hole-transport layer, and a hole-inject layer in this order over thecathode 7003. It is not necessary to form all of these layers. Theanode 7005 is formed using a light-transmitting conductive film such as a film of indium oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium zinc oxide containing tungsten oxide, indium oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide containing titanium oxide, indium tin oxide (hereinafter referred to as ITO), indium zinc oxide, or indium tin oxide to which silicon oxide is added. - The light-emitting
element 7002 corresponds to a region where the light-emittinglayer 7004 is sandwiched between thecathode 7003 and theanode 7005. In the case of the pixel illustrated inFIG. 19A , light is emitted from the light-emittingelement 7002 to theanode 7005 side as indicated by an arrow. - Next, a light-emitting element having a bottom emission structure will be described with reference to
FIG. 19B .FIG. 19B is a cross-sectional view of a pixel in the case where the drivingTFT 7011 is of an n-type and light is emitted from a light-emittingelement 7012 to acathode 7013 side. InFIG. 19B , thecathode 7013 of the light-emittingelement 7012 is formed over a light-transmittingconductive film 7017 that is electrically connected to the drivingTFT 7011, and a light-emittinglayer 7014 and ananode 7015 are stacked in this order over thecathode 7013. A light-blockingfilm 7016 for reflecting or blocking light may be formed to cover theanode 7015 when theanode 7015 has a light-transmitting property. For thecathode 7013, a variety of materials can be used as in the case ofFIG. 19A as long as they are conductive materials having a low work function. Thecathode 7013 is formed to have a thickness that can transmit light (preferably, approximately 5 nm to 30 nm). For example, an aluminum film with a thickness of 20 nm can be used as thecathode 7013. Similar to the case ofFIG. 19A , the light-emittinglayer 7014 may be formed using either a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked. Theanode 7015 does not need to transmit light, but can be formed using a light-transmitting conductive material as in the case ofFIG. 19A . As the light-blockingfilm 7016, a metal or the like that reflects light can be used for example; however, it is not limited to a metal film. For example, a resin or the like to which black pigments are added can also be used. - The light-emitting
element 7012 corresponds to a region where the light-emittinglayer 7014 is sandwiched between thecathode 7013 and theanode 7015. In the case of the pixel illustrated inFIG. 19B , light is emitted from the light-emittingelement 7012 to thecathode 7013 side as indicated by an arrow. - Next, a light-emitting element having a dual emission structure will be described with reference to
FIG. 19C . InFIG. 19C , acathode 7023 of a light-emittingelement 7022 is formed over a light-transmittingconductive film 7027 which is electrically connected to the drivingTFT 7021, and a light-emittinglayer 7024 and ananode 7025 are stacked in this order over thecathode 7023. As in the case ofFIG. 19A , thecathode 7023 can be formed using a variety of conductive materials as long as they have a low work function. Thecathode 7023 is formed to have a thickness which allows light transmission. For example, a 20-nm-thich aluminum film can be used as thecathode 7023. As inFIG. 19A , the light-emittinglayer 7024 may be formed using either a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked. Theanode 7025 can be formed using a light-transmitting conductive material as in the case ofFIG. 19A . - The light-emitting
element 7022 corresponds to a region where thecathode 7023, the light-emittinglayer 7024, and theanode 7025 overlap with one another. In the case of the pixel illustrated inFIG. 19C , light is emitted from the light-emittingelement 7022 to both theanode 7025 side and thecathode 7023 side as indicated by arrows. - Note that, although the organic EL elements are described here as the light-emitting elements, an inorganic EL element can also be provided as a light-emitting element.
- Note that the example is described in which a thin film transistor (a driving TFT) which controls the driving of a light-emitting element is electrically connected to the light-emitting element; however, a structure may be employed in which a TFT for current control is connected between the driving TFT and the light-emitting element.
- Note that the structure of the semiconductor device is not limited to those illustrated in
FIGS. 19A to 19C and can be modified in various ways based on techniques disclosed in this specification. - Next, the appearance and cross section of a light-emitting display panel (also referred to as a light-emitting panel) which corresponds to one embodiment of the semiconductor device will be described with reference to
FIGS. 17A and 17B .FIG. 17A is a plan view of a panel in which a thin film transistor and a light-emitting element formed over a first substrate are sealed between the first substrate and a second substrate with a sealant.FIG. 17B is a cross-sectional view along line H-I ofFIG. 17A . - A
sealant 4505 is provided so as to surround apixel portion 4502, signalline driver circuits line driver circuits first substrate 4501. In addition, asecond substrate 4506 is provided over thepixel portion 4502, the signalline driver circuits line driver circuits pixel portion 4502, the signalline driver circuits line driver circuits filler 4507, by thefirst substrate 4501, thesealant 4505, and thesecond substrate 4506. It is preferable that a panel be packaged (sealed) with a protective film (such as a laminate film or an ultraviolet curable resin film) or a cover material with high air-tightness and little degasification so that the panel is not exposed to the outside air, in this manner. - The
pixel portion 4502, the signalline driver circuits line driver circuits first substrate 4501 each include a plurality of thin film transistors, and athin film transistor 4510 included in thepixel portion 4502 and athin film transistor 4509 included in the signalline driver circuit 4503 a are illustrated as an example inFIG. 17B . - For the
thin film transistors Embodiment 3 can be employed. Alternatively, the thin film transistor described inEmbodiment thin film transistors - Moreover,
reference numeral 4511 denotes a light-emitting element. Afirst electrode layer 4517 which is a pixel electrode included in the light-emittingelement 4511 is electrically connected to a source electrode layer or a drain electrode layer of thethin film transistor 4510. Note that the structure of the light-emittingelement 4511 is, but not limited to, the stack structure which includes thefirst electrode layer 4517, anelectroluminescent layer 4512, and thesecond electrode layer 4513. The structure of the light-emittingelement 4511 can be changed as appropriate depending on the direction in which light is extracted from the light-emittingelement 4511, or the like. - A
partition 4520 is formed using an organic resin film, an inorganic insulating film, or organic polysiloxane. It is particularly preferable that thepartition 4520 be formed using a photosensitive material and an opening be formed over thefirst electrode layer 4517 so that a sidewall of the opening is formed as an inclined surface with continuous curvature. - The
electroluminescent layer 4512 may be formed with a single layer or a plurality of layers stacked. - A protective film may be formed over the
second electrode layer 4513 and thepartition 4520 in order to prevent entry of oxygen, hydrogen, moisture, carbon dioxide, or the like into the light-emittingelement 4511. As the protective film, a silicon nitride film, a silicon nitride oxide film, a DLC film, or the like can be formed. - In addition, a variety of signals and potentials are supplied to the signal
line driver circuits line driver circuits pixel portion 4502 fromFPCs - A
connection terminal electrode 4515 is formed from the same conductive film as thefirst electrode layer 4517 included in the light-emittingelement 4511, and aterminal electrode 4516 is formed from the same conductive film as the source and drain electrode layers included in thethin film transistors - The
connection terminal electrode 4515 is electrically connected to a terminal included in theFPC 4518 a via an anisotropicconductive film 4519. - As the
second substrate 4506 located in the direction in which light is extracted from the light-emittingelement 4511 needs to have a light-transmitting property. In that case, a light-transmitting material such as a glass plate, a plastic plate, a polyester film, or an acrylic film is used for thesecond substrate 4506. - As the
filler 4507, an ultraviolet curable resin or a thermosetting resin can be used, in addition to an inert gas such as nitrogen or argon. For example, PVC (polyvinyl chloride), acrylic, polyimide, an epoxy resin, a silicone resin, PVB (polyvinyl butyral), or EVA (ethylene vinyl acetate) can be used. For example, nitrogen is used for the filler. - In addition, if needed, an optical film, such as a polarizing plate, a circularly polarizing plate (including an elliptically polarizing plate), a retardation plate (a quarter-wave plate or a half-wave plate), or a color filter, may be provided as appropriate on a light-emitting surface of the light-emitting element. Further, the polarizing plate or the circularly polarizing plate may be provided with an anti-reflection film. For example, anti-glare treatment by which reflected light can be diffused by projections and depressions on the surface so as to reduce the glare can be performed.
- The signal
line driver circuits line driver circuits FIGS. 17A and 17B . - Through the above process, a highly reliable light-emitting display device (display panel) as a semiconductor device can be manufactured.
- This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- A semiconductor device disclosed in this specification can be applied to an electronic paper. An electronic paper can be used for electronic appliances of a variety of fields as long as they can display data. For example, an electronic paper can be applied to an e-book reader (electronic book), a poster, an advertisement in a vehicle such as a train, or displays of various cards such as a credit card. Examples of such electronic appliances are illustrated in
FIG. 27 . -
FIG. 27 illustrates an example of ane-book reader 2700. For example, thee-book reader 2700 includes two housings, ahousing 2701 and ahousing 2703. Thehousing 2701 and thehousing 2703 are combined with ahinge 2711 so that thee-book reader 2700 can be opened and closed with thehinge 2711 as an axis. With such a structure, thee-book reader 2700 can operate like a paper book. - A
display portion 2705 and adisplay portion 2707 are incorporated in thehousing 2701 and thehousing 2703, respectively. Thedisplay portion 2705 and thedisplay portion 2707 may display one image or different images. In the case where thedisplay portion 2705 and thedisplay portion 2707 display different images, for example, a display portion on the right side (thedisplay portion 2705 inFIG. 27 ) can display text and a display portion on the left side (thedisplay portion 2707 inFIG. 27 ) can display graphics. -
FIG. 27 illustrates an example in which thehousing 2701 is provided with an operation portion and the like. For example, thehousing 2701 is provided with apower switch 2721, anoperation key 2723, aspeaker 2725, and the like. With theoperation key 2723, pages can be turned. Note that a keyboard, a pointing device, or the like may also be provided on the surface of the housing, on which the display portion is provided. Furthermore, an external connection terminal (an earphone terminal, a USB terminal, a terminal that can be connected to various cables such as an AC adapter and a USB cable, or the like), a recording medium insertion portion, and the like may be provided on the back surface or the side surface of the housing. Moreover, thee-book reader 2700 may have a function of an electronic dictionary. - The
e-book reader 2700 may have a configuration capable of wirelessly transmitting and receiving data. Through wireless communication, desired book data or the like can be purchased and downloaded from an electronic book server. - A semiconductor device disclosed in this specification can be applied to a variety of electronic appliances (including game machines). Examples of electronic appliances are a television set (also referred to as a television or a television receiver), a monitor of a computer or the like, a camera such as a digital camera or a digital video camera, a digital photo frame, a mobile phone handset (also referred to as a mobile phone or a mobile phone device), a portable game console, a portable information terminal, an audio reproducing device, a large-sized game machine such as a pachinko machine, and the like.
-
FIG. 28A illustrates an example of atelevision set 9600. In thetelevision set 9600, adisplay portion 9603 is incorporated in ahousing 9601. Thedisplay portion 9603 can display images. Here, thehousing 9601 is supported by astand 9605. - The
television set 9600 can be operated with an operation switch of thehousing 9601 or a separateremote controller 9610. Channels and volume can be controlled with anoperation key 9609 of theremote controller 9610 so that an image displayed on thedisplay portion 9603 can be controlled. Furthermore, theremote controller 9610 may be provided with adisplay portion 9607 for displaying data output from theremote controller 9610. - Note that the
television set 9600 is provided with a receiver, a modem, and the like. With the use of the receiver, general television broadcasting can be received. Moreover, when the display device is connected to a communication network with or without wires via the modem, one-way (from a sender to a receiver) or two-way (between a sender and a receiver or between receivers) information communication can be performed. -
FIG. 28B illustrates an example of adigital photo frame 9700. For example, in thedigital photo frame 9700, adisplay portion 9703 is incorporated in ahousing 9701. Thedisplay portion 9703 can display a variety of images. For example, thedisplay portion 9703 can display data of an image taken with a digital camera or the like and function as a normal photo frame. - Note that the
digital photo frame 9700 is provided with an operation portion, an external connection terminal (a USB terminal, a terminal that can be connected to various cables such as a USB cable, or the like), a recording medium insertion portion, and the like. Although these components may be provided on the surface on which the display portion is provided, it is preferable to provide them on the side surface or the back surface for the design of thedigital photo frame 9700. For example, a memory storing data of an image taken with a digital camera is inserted in the recording medium insertion portion of the digital photo frame, whereby the image data can be transferred and then displayed on thedisplay portion 9703. - The
digital photo frame 9700 may be configured to transmit and receive data wirelessly. The structure may be employed in which desired image data is transferred wirelessly to be displayed. -
FIG. 29A is a portable game machine and includes two housings, ahousing 9881 and ahousing 9891, which are connected with ajoint portion 9893 so that the portable game machine can be opened or folded. Adisplay portion 9882 and adisplay portion 9883 are incorporated in thehousing 9881 and thehousing 9891, respectively. In addition, the portable game machine illustrated inFIG. 29A includes aspeaker portion 9884, a recordingmedium insertion portion 9886, anLED lamp 9890, an input means (anoperation key 9885, aconnection terminal 9887, a sensor 9888 (a sensor having a function of measuring force, displacement, position, speed, acceleration, angular velocity, rotational frequency, distance, light, liquid, magnetism, temperature, chemical substance, sound, time, hardness, electric field, current, voltage, electric power, radiation, flow rate, humidity, gradient, oscillation, odor, or infrared rays), or a microphone 9889), and the like. It is needless to say that the structure of the portable game machine is not limited to the above and other structures provided with at least a semiconductor device disclosed in this specification can be employed. The portable game machine may include other accessory equipment as appropriate. The portable game machine illustrated inFIG. 29A has a function of reading a program or data stored in a recording medium to display it on the display portion, and a function of sharing information with another portable game machine via wireless communication. Note that a function of the portable game machine illustrated inFIG. 29A is not limited to those described above, and the portable game machine can have a variety of functions. -
FIG. 29B illustrates an example of aslot machine 9900 which is a large-sized game machine. In theslot machine 9900, adisplay portion 9903 is incorporated in ahousing 9901. In addition, theslot machine 9900 includes an operation means such as a start lever or a stop switch, a coin slot, a speaker, and the like. It is needless to say that the structure of theslot machine 9900 is not limited to the above and other structures provided with at least a semiconductor device disclosed in this specification may be employed. Theslot machine 9900 may include other accessory equipment as appropriate. -
FIG. 30A is a perspective view illustrating an example of a portable computer. - In the portable computer of
FIG. 30A , atop housing 9301 having adisplay portion 9303 and abottom housing 9302 having akeyboard 9304 can overlap with each other by closing a hinge unit which connects thetop housing 9301 and thebottom housing 9302. The portable computer ofFIG. 30A can be convenient for carrying, and in the case of using the keyboard for input, the hinge unit is opened and the user can input data looking at thedisplay portion 9303. - The
bottom housing 9302 includes apointing device 9306 with which input can be performed, in addition to thekeyboard 9304. Further, when thedisplay portion 9303 is a touch input panel, input can be performed by touching part of the display portion. Thebottom housing 9302 includes an arithmetic function portion such as a CPU or hard disk. In addition, thebottom housing 9302 includes another device, for example, anexternal connection port 9305 into which a communication cable conformable to communication standards of a USB is inserted. - The
top housing 9301, which includes adisplay portion 9307 and can keep thedisplay portion 9307 therein by sliding it toward the inside of thetop housing 9301, can have a large display screen. In addition, the user can adjust the orientation of a screen of thedisplay portion 9307 which can be kept in thetop housing 9301. When thedisplay portion 9307 which can be kept in thetop housing 9301 is a touch input panel, input can be performed by touching part of thedisplay portion 9307 which can be kept in thetop housing 9301. - The
display portion 9303 or thedisplay portion 9307 which can be kept in thetop housing 9301 are formed using an image display device of a liquid crystal display panel, a light-emitting display panel such as an organic light-emitting element or an inorganic light-emitting element, or the like. - In addition, the portable computer in
FIG. 30A can be provided with a receiver and the like and can receive a television broadcast to display an image on the display portion. The user can watch a television broadcast when the whole screen of thedisplay portion 9307 is exposed by sliding thedisplay portion 9307 while the hinge unit which connects thetop housing 9301 and thebottom housing 9302 is kept closed. In this case, the hinge unit is not opened and display is not performed on thedisplay portion 9303. In addition, start up of only a circuit for displaying a television broadcast is performed. Therefore, power can be consumed to the minimum, which is useful for the portable computer whose battery capacity is limited. -
FIG. 30B is a perspective view illustrating an example of a mobile phone that the user can wear on the wrist like a wristwatch. - This mobile phone is formed with a main body which includes a communication device including at least a telephone function, and battery; a band portion which enables the main body to be wore on the wrist; an adjusting
portion 9205 for adjusting the fixation of the band portion fixed for the wrist; adisplay portion 9201; aspeaker 9207; and amicrophone 9208. - In addition, the main body includes operation switches 9203. The operation switches 9203 can serve, for example, as a switch for starting a program for the Internet when the switch is pushed, in addition to serving as a switch for turning on a power source, a switch for shifting the display, a switch for instruction to start taking images, or the like, and can be configured to have respective functions.
- Input to this mobile phone is operated by touching the
display portion 9201 with a finger or an input pen, operating the operation switches 9203, or inputting voice into themicrophone 9208. Note that displayedbuttons 9202 which are displayed on thedisplay portion 9201 are illustrated inFIG. 30B . Input can be performed by touching the displayedbuttons 9202 with a finger or the like. - Further, the main body includes a
camera portion 9206 including an image pick-up means having a function of converting an image of an object, which is formed through a camera lens, to an electronic image signal. Note that the camera portion is not necessarily provided. - The mobile phone illustrated in
FIG. 30B is provided with a receiver of a television broadcast and the like, and can display an image on thedisplay portion 9201 by receiving a television broadcast. In addition, the mobile phone illustrated inFIG. 30B is provided with a memory device and the like such as a memory, and can record a television broadcast in the memory. The mobile phone illustrated inFIG. 30B may have a function of collecting location information, such as the GPS. - An image display device of a liquid crystal display panel, a light-emitting display panel such as an organic light-emitting element or an inorganic light-emitting element, or the like is used as the
display portion 9201. The cellular phone illustrated inFIG. 30B is compact and lightweight and the battery capacity of the cellular phone illustrated inFIG. 30B is limited. Therefore, a panel which can be driven with low power consumption is preferably used as a display device for thedisplay portion 9201. - Note that
FIG. 30B illustrates the electronic appliances which are worn on the wrist; however, this embodiment is not limited thereto as long as a portable shape is employed. - In this embodiment, an example of a manufacturing process which is partly different from that of
Embodiment 1 will be described. An example in which heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed after formation of source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b is illustrated inFIGS. 31A to 31D . Note that portions the same as those inFIGS. 6A to 6D are denoted by the same reference numerals. - In a manner similar to
Embodiment 1, over thesubstrate 400 having an insulating surface, thegate electrode layer 401, thegate insulating layer 402, and theoxide semiconductor layer 430 are formed (seeFIG. 31A ). - The source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b are formed over the
oxide semiconductor layer 430, and theoxide semiconductor layer 430 is partly etched, so that anoxide semiconductor layer 441 is formed (seeFIG. 31B ). - Next, the
oxide semiconductor layer 441 and the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b are subjected to heat treatment and slow cooling under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure. This heat treatment causes dehydration or dehydrogenation in theoxide semiconductor layer 441, so that resistance of theoxide semiconductor layer 441 is reduced. Thus, the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 432 can be obtained (seeFIG. 31C ). Note that as the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b, a material which has heat resistance enough to withstand heat treatment, such as tungsten or molybdenum, is preferably used. - After the heat treatment and slow cooling, the
oxide insulating film 407 is formed to be in contact with theoxide semiconductor layer 432 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method without exposure to air. When theoxide insulating film 407 is formed to be in contact with the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 432 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method, in the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 432, at least a region in contact with theoxide insulating film 407 has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3, more preferably 1×1014/cm3 or lower), so that a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained. Thus, theoxide semiconductor layer 432 becomes thesemiconductor layer 403 having a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region (a third oxide semiconductor layer), and then thethin film transistor 470 can be completed (seeFIG. 31D ). - Impurities (such as H2O, H, and OH) contained in the oxide semiconductor layer are reduced by performance of the heat treatment for dehydration or dehydrogenation, and the carrier concentration is increased. After that, slow cooling is performed. Then, formation of an oxide insulating film in contact with the oxide semiconductor layer, or the like, is performed, so that the carrier concentration is reduced. Thus, reliability of the
thin film transistor 470 can be improved. - Further, this embodiment can be freely combined with
Embodiment 1. - A semiconductor device and a method of manufacturing the semiconductor device will be described with reference to
FIG. 32 . The same portion as or a portion having similar function to those described inEmbodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described inEmbodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted. - The
thin film transistor 471 illustrated inFIG. 32 is an example, in which aconductive layer 409 is provided to overlap with thegate electrode layer 401 and a channel region of thesemiconductor layer 403 with an insulating film interposed therebetween. -
FIG. 32 is a cross-sectional view of thethin film transistor 471 included in a semiconductor device. Thethin film transistor 471 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over thesubstrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, thegate electrode layer 401, thegate insulating layer 402, thesemiconductor layer 403, the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b, and theconductive layer 409. Theconductive layer 409 is provided over theoxide insulating film 407 so as to overlap with thegate electrode layer 401. - The
conductive layer 409 can be formed using a material similar to that of thegate electrode layer 401 or the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b by a method similar thereto. In the case of providing a pixel electrode layer, theconductive layer 409 may be formed using a material similar to that of the pixel electrode by a method similar thereto. In this embodiment, theconductive layer 409 is formed using a stacked layer of a titanium film, an aluminum film, and a titanium film. - The
conductive layer 409 may have the same potential as thegate electrode layer 401 or have potential different from that of thegate electrode layer 401 and can function as a second gate electrode layer. Further, theconductive layer 409 may be in a floating state. - In addition, by providing the
conductive layer 409 in a position overlapping with thesemiconductor layer 403, in a bias-temperature stress test (BT test) for examining reliability of a thin film transistor, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of thethin film transistor 471 between before and after the BT test can be reduced. In particular, in a −BT test where −20 V of voltage is applied to a gate after the substrate temperature is increased to 150° C., shift in threshold voltage can be suppressed. - This embodiment can be freely combined with
Embodiment 1. - A semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to
FIG. 33 . The same portion as or a portion having similar function to those described inEmbodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described inEmbodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted. - A
thin film transistor 472 illustrated inFIG. 33 is an example, in which aconductive layer 419 is provided to overlap with thegate electrode layer 401 and a channel region of thesemiconductor layer 403 with theoxide insulating film 407 and an insulatinglayer 410 interposed therebetween. -
FIG. 33 is a cross-sectional view of thethin film transistor 472 included in a semiconductor device. Thethin film transistor 472 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor and includes, over thesubstrate 400 which is a substrate having an insulating surface, thegate electrode layer 401, thegate insulating layer 402, thesemiconductor layer 403, source and drainregions conductive layer 419. Theconductive layer 419 is provided over theoxide insulating film 407 and the insulatinglayer 410 to overlap with thegate electrode layer 401. - In this embodiment, the insulating
layer 410 serving as a planarization film is stacked over theoxide insulating film 407, and an opening which reaches the source or drainelectrode layer 405 b is formed in theoxide insulating film 407 and the insulatinglayer 410. A conductive film is formed over the insulatinglayer 410 and in the opening formed in theoxide insulating film 407 and the insulatinglayer 410, and etched into a desired shape, so that theconductive layer 419 and apixel electrode layer 411 are formed. In such a manner, theconductive layer 419 can be formed together with thepixel electrode layer 411, using the same material by the same method. In this embodiment, thepixel electrode layer 411 and theconductive layer 419 are formed using indium oxide-tin oxide alloy containing silicon oxide (an In—Sn—O based oxide containing silicon oxide). - The
conductive layer 419 may be formed using a material similar to that of thegate electrode layer 401 or the source and drain electrode layers 405 a and 405 b by a method similar thereto. - The
conductive layer 419 may have the same potential as thegate electrode layer 401 or have potential different from that of thegate electrode layer 401 and can function as a second gate electrode layer. Further, theconductive layer 419 may be in a floating state. - In addition, in the case of providing the
conductive layer 419 in a portion overlapping with thesemiconductor layer 403, in a bias-temperature stress test (BT test) for examining reliability of a thin film transistor, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of thethin film transistor 472 between before and after the BT test can be reduced. - This embodiment can be freely combined with
Embodiment 1. - In this embodiment, an example of a channel-stop
thin film transistor 1430 will be described with reference toFIGS. 34A to 34C .FIG. 34C illustrates an example of a top view of the thin film transistor, cross-sectional view along dotted line Z1-Z2 of which corresponds toFIG. 34B . Described in this embodiment is an example in which gallium is not contained in an oxide semiconductor layer of thethin film transistor 1430. - As in
FIG. 34A , agate electrode layer 1401 is formed over asubstrate 1400. Next, an oxide semiconductor layer is formed over agate insulating layer 1402 covering thegate electrode layer 1401. - In this embodiment, the oxide semiconductor layer is formed using a Sn-Zn-O-based oxide semiconductor by a sputtering method. When gallium is not used for the oxide semiconductor layer, cost can be reduced because an expensive target is not used in formation of the oxide semiconductor layer.
- Just after deposition of an oxide semiconductor film or after patterning of the oxide semiconductor film, dehydration or dehydrogenation is performed.
- In order to perform dehydration or dehydrogenation, heat treatment is performed under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure, and then, slow cooling is performed under an inert atmosphere. The heat treatment is performed at 200° C. to 600° C. inclusive, preferably 400° C. to 450° C. inclusive. By heat treatment and slow cooling performed under an inert-gas atmosphere or under reduced pressure, the oxide semiconductor layer can have reduced resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is increased, preferably to 1×1018/cm3 or higher), so that a low-resistance
oxide semiconductor layer 1403 can be provided (seeFIG. 34A ). - Next, a channel
protective layer 1418 is provided to be in contact with theoxide semiconductor layer 1403. The channelprotective layer 1418 can prevent the channel formation region of theoxide semiconductor layer 1403 to be damaged in the manufacturing process (e.g., reduction in thickness due to plasma or an etchant in etching). Accordingly, reliability of thethin film transistor 1430 can be improved. - Further, after dehydration or dehydrogenation, the channel
protective layer 1418 can be formed successively without exposure to air. Successive film formation without being exposed to air makes it possible to obtain each interface of stacked layers, which are not contaminated by atmospheric components or impurity elements floating in air. Therefore, variation in characteristics of the thin film transistor can be reduced. - When the channel
protective layer 1418 that is an oxide insulating film is formed to be in contact with the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 1403, by a sputtering method, a PCVD method, or the like, in the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 1403, at least a region which is in contact with the channelprotective layer 1418 can have increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3, more preferably 1×1014/cm3 or lower). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be obtained. During a manufacture process of a semiconductor device, it is important to increase and decrease the carrier concentration in the oxide semiconductor layer through performance of heat treatment and slow cooling under an inert-gas atmosphere (or reduced pressure), formation of an oxide insulating film, and the like. - The channel
protective layer 1418 can be formed using an inorganic material including oxygen (such as silicon oxide, silicon oxynitride, or silicon nitride oxide). As a formation method, a vapor deposition method such as a plasma CVD method or a thermal CVD method or a sputtering method can be used. The channelprotective layer 1418 is processed by etching a shape of a deposited film. Here, the channelprotective layer 1418 is formed in such a manner that a silicon oxide film is formed by a sputtering method and processed by etching using a mask formed by photolithography. - Next, n+ layers 1406 a and 1406 b are formed over the channel
protective layer 1418 and theoxide semiconductor layer 1403. In this embodiment, the n+ layers 1406 a and 1406 b serving as source and drain regions, which are oxide semiconductor layers having lower resistance, are formed of an Al-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film under deposition conditions different from the deposition conditions of theoxide semiconductor layer 1403. The n+ layers 1406 a and 1406 b may be formed using an Al-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film containing nitrogen, that is, an Al-Zn-O-N-based non-single-crystal film (also called an AZON film). - Next, a
source electrode layer 1405 a and adrain electrode layer 1405 b are formed over the n| layer 1406 a and then layer 1406 b, respectively; thus, thethin film transistor 1430 is completed (seeFIG. 34B ). The source and drainelectrode layers electrode layers - Provision of the n+ layers 1406 a and 1406 b can make a good junction between the
oxide semiconductor layer 1403 and the source and drainelectrode layers 1405 a and 1405 which are metal layers, which allows higher thermal stability than in the case of providing Schottky junction. In addition, willing provision of the n+ layer is effective in supplying carriers to the channel (on the source side), stably absorbing carriers from the channel (on the drain side), or preventing a resistance component from being formed at an interface between the wiring and the oxide semiconductor layer. Moreover, since resistance is reduced, good mobility can be ensured even with a high drain voltage. - Further, this embodiment is not limited to the above-described structure including the n+ layers 1406 a and 1406 b; a structure in which an n+ layer is not provided may be employed.
- After the channel
protective layer 1418 is formed, thethin film transistor 1430 is subjected to heat treatment under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air) (at a temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C.). For example, heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for one hour. In such heat treatment, theoxide semiconductor layer 1403 in a condition of being in contact with the channelprotective layer 1418 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of the thin film transistor 1470 can be reduced. There is no particular limitation on when to perform this heat treatment (at temperature equal to or higher than 150° C. and lower than 350° C., preferably) as long as it is performed after the channelprotective layer 1418 is formed. When this heat treatment also serves as heat treatment in another step, e.g., heat treatment in formation of a resin film or heat treatment for reducing resistance of a transparent conductive film, the number of steps can be prevented from increasing. - This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- A semiconductor device and a method for manufacturing a semiconductor device will be described with reference to
FIGS. 35A and 35B . The same portion or a portion having a function similar to that ofEmbodiment 13 and the same steps as those ofEmbodiment 13 can be made as described inEmbodiment 13; thus the repetitive description thereof is omitted. - A
thin film transistor 1431 illustrated inFIG. 35A is an example having a structure in which aconductive layer 1409 is provided to overlap with thegate electrode layer 1401 and a channel region of theoxide semiconductor layer 1403 with the channelprotective layer 1418 and an insulatinglayer 1407 interposed therebetween. -
FIG. 35A is a cross-sectional view of thethin film transistor 1431 included in a semiconductor device. Thethin film transistor 1431 is a bottom-gate thin film transistor, which includes, over thesubstrate 1400 having an insulating surface, thegate electrode layer 1401, thegate insulating layer 1402, theoxide semiconductor layer 1403, the source and drain regions 1404 a and 1404 b, the source and drainelectrode layers conductive layer 1409. Theconductive layer 1409 is provided to overlap with thegate electrode layer 1401 with the insulatinglayer 1407 interposed therebetween. - The
conductive layer 1409 can be formed using a material similar to that of thegate electrode layer 1401 or the source and drainelectrode layers conductive layer 1409 may be formed using a material similar to that of the pixel electrode layer by a method similar thereto. In this embodiment, a stack of a titanium film, an aluminum film, and a titanium film is used as theconductive layer 1409. - The
conductive layer 1409 may have the same potential as thegate electrode layer 1401 or have potential different from that of thegate electrode layer 1401 and can function as a second gate electrode layer. Further, theconductive layer 1409 may be in a floating state. - In addition, by providing the
conductive layer 1409 in a portion overlapping with theoxide semiconductor layer 1403, in a bias-temperature stress test (hereinafter, referred to as a BT test) for examining reliability of a thin film transistor, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of thethin film transistor 1431 between before and after the BT test can be reduced. -
FIG. 35B illustrates an example partly different fromFIG. 35A . The same portion and a step as, or a portion having function similar to those illustrated inFIG. 35A can be made in a manner similar to that illustrated inFIG. 35A ; therefore, repetitive description is omitted. - A
thin film transistor 1432 illustrated inFIG. 35B is an example having a structure in which theconductive layer 1409 is provided to overlap with thegate electrode layer 1401 and a channel region of theoxide semiconductor layer 1403 with the channelprotective layer 1418, the insulatinglayer 1407, and an insulatinglayer 1408 interposed between theconductive layer 1409 and thegate electrode layer 1401. - In
FIG. 35B , the insulatinglayer 1408 functioning as a planarization film is stacked over the insulatinglayer 1407. - In addition,
FIG. 35B shows a structure in which source and drain regions are not provided, and theoxide semiconductor layer 1403 is directly in contact with thesource electrode layer 1405 a and thedrain electrode layer 1405 b. - The
conductive layer 1409 is provided in a portion overlapping with theoxide semiconductor layer 1403 in the structure ofFIG. 35B similar toFIG. 35A , whereby in a bias-temperature stress test for examining reliability of a thin film transistor, the amount of shift in threshold voltage of thethin film transistor 1432 between before and after the BT test can be reduced. - This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- In this embodiment, an example of a structure which is partly different from that of
Embodiment 1 will be described with reference toFIG. 36 . The same portion as or a portion having a function similar to those described inEmbodiment 1 can be formed in a manner similar to that described inEmbodiment 1, and also the steps similar to those ofEmbodiment 1 can be performed in a manner similar to those described inEmbodiment 1; therefore, repetitive description is omitted. - In this embodiment, after patterning of the first oxide semiconductor layer, heat treatment is performed under an atmosphere of an inert gas (such as nitrogen, helium, neon, or argon) or under reduced pressure, and then slow cooling is performed. Heat treatment performed on the first oxide semiconductor layer under the above atmosphere makes it possible to eliminate impurities such as hydrogen and moisture in an
oxide semiconductor layer 403. - Next, a second oxide semiconductor film used for forming source and drain regions (also referred to as an n| layer or a buffer layer) of a thin film transistor is formed over the first oxide semiconductor layer and then a conductive film is formed.
- Then, the first oxide semiconductor layer, the second oxide semiconductor film, and the conductive film are selectively etched through an etching step to form the
oxide semiconductor layer 403, source and drainregions oxide semiconductor layer 403 is partly etched to have a groove portion (a recessed portion). - Next, a silicon oxide film as the
oxide insulating film 407 is formed in contact with theoxide semiconductor layer 403 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method. Theoxide insulating film 407 formed in contact with the low-resistance oxide semiconductor layer does not include impurities such as moisture, a hydrogen ion, and OH− and is formed using an inorganic insulating film which blocks entry of these impurities from the outside, specifically, a silicon oxide film or a silicon nitride oxide film. - When the
oxide insulating film 407 is formed in contact with the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 403 by a sputtering method or a PCVD method, or the like, in the low-resistanceoxide semiconductor layer 403, at least a region in contact with theoxide insulating film 407 has increased resistance (i.e., the carrier concentration is reduced, preferably to lower than 1×1018/cm3, more preferably 1×1014/cm3 or lower). Thus, a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region can be provided. By formation of theoxide insulating film 407 in contact with theoxide semiconductor layer 403, the oxide semiconductor layer has a high-resistance oxide semiconductor region. Thus, athin film transistor 473 can be completed (seeFIG. 36 ). - In the structure illustrated in
FIG. 36 , an In-Ga-Zn-O-based non-single-crystal film is used for the source and drain regions (also referred to as n+ layers or buffer layers) 404 a and 404 b. - In addition, the source region is provided between the
oxide semiconductor layer 403 and the source electrode layer, and the drain region is provided between theoxide semiconductor layer 403 and the drain electrode layer. As the source and drain regions, an oxide semiconductor layer having an n-type conductivity is used. - Further, the second oxide semiconductor film used for the source and drain
regions thin film transistor 473 is preferably thinner than the first oxide semiconductor layer used for a channel formation region and preferably has conductivity (electrical conductivity) higher than the first oxide semiconductor layer. - Further, the first oxide semiconductor layer used for the channel formation region has an amorphous structure and the second oxide semiconductor film used for the source region and the drain region includes a crystal grain (nanocrystal) in an amorphous structure in some cases. The crystal grain (nanocrystal) in the second oxide semiconductor film used for the source region and the drain region has a diameter of 1 nm to 10 nm, typically about 2 nm to 4 nm.
- After formation of the
oxide insulating film 407, thethin film transistor 473 may be subjected to heat treatment (preferably at a temperature higher than or equal to 150° C. and lower than 350° C.) under a nitrogen atmosphere or an air atmosphere (in air). For example, heat treatment is performed under a nitrogen atmosphere at 250° C. for one hour. In such heat treatment, theoxide semiconductor layer 403 in a condition of being in contact with theoxide insulating film 407 is heated; thus, variation in electric characteristics of thethin film transistor 473 can be reduced. - This embodiment can be implemented in appropriate combination with the structures described in the other embodiments.
- On the present invention having the above-described structures, further specific description will be made with an embodiments below.
- With respect to an oxide semiconductor layer including a region having high oxygen density and a region having low oxygen density, a change in the oxygen density between before and after heat treatment was simulated. The result thereof will be described with reference to
FIG. 42 andFIG. 43 in this example. As software for the simulation, Materials Explorer 5.0 manufactured by Fujitsu Limited was used. -
FIG. 42 illustrates a model of an oxide semiconductor layer which was used for the simulation. Here, a structure in which alayer 1203 having low oxygen density and alayer 1205 having high oxygen density were stacked was employed for anoxide semiconductor layer 1201. - The
layer 1203 having low oxygen density was formed to have an amorphous structure including In atoms, Ga atoms, Zn atoms, and O atoms, where the numbers of In atoms, Ga atoms, and Zn atoms were each 15 and the number of O atoms was 54. - In addition, the
layer 1205 having high oxygen density was formed to have an amorphous structure including In atoms, Ga atoms, Zn atoms, and O atoms, where the numbers of In atoms, Ga atoms, and Zn atoms were each 15 and the number of O atoms was 66. - The density of the
oxide semiconductor layer 1201 was set to 5.9 g/cm3. - Next, the classical molecular dynamics (MD) simulation was performed on the
oxide semiconductor layer 1201 under conditions of NVT ensemble and a temperature of 250° C. The time step was set to 0.2 fs, and the total simulation time was set to 200 ps. In addition, Born-Mayer-Huggins potential was used for the potentials of metal-oxygen bonding and oxygen-oxygen bonding. Moreover, movement of atoms at an upper end portion and a lower end portion of theoxide semiconductor layer 1201 was fixed. - The simulation results are shown in
FIG. 43 . In z-axis coordinates, the range of 0 nm to 1.15 nm indicates thelayer 1203 having low oxygen density, and the range of 1.15 nm to 2.3 nm indicates thelayer 1205 having high oxygen density. The distribution of oxygen densities before the MD simulation is indicated by asolid line 1207, and the distribution of oxygen densities after the MD simulation is indicated by a dashedline 1209. - The
solid line 1207 shows that theoxide semiconductor layer 1201 has high oxygen densities in a region ranging from an interface between thelayer 1203 having low oxygen density and thelayer 1205 having high oxygen density to thelayer 1205 having high oxygen concentration. On the other hand, the dashedline 1209 shows that the oxygen density is uniform in thelayer 1203 having low oxygen density and thelayer 1205 having high oxygen density. - From the above, when there is non-uniformity in the distribution of oxygen density as in the stack of the
layer 1203 having low oxygen density and thelayer 1205 having high oxygen density, it is found that the oxygen density from where the oxygen density is higher to where the oxygen density is lower by heat treatment and thus the oxygen density becomes uniform. - That is, as described in
Embodiment 1, since the oxygen density at the interface between theoxide semiconductor layer 403 and theoxide insulating film 407 is increased by formation of theoxide insulating film 407 over the firstoxide semiconductor layer 403, the oxygen diffuses to theoxide semiconductor layer 403 where the oxygen density is low and thus thesemiconductor layer 403 has higher resistance. As described above, reliability of a thin film transistor can be improved. - This application is based on Japanese Patent Application serial no. 2009-156410 filed with Japan Patent Office on Jun. 30, 2009, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.
Claims (16)
Priority Applications (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US16/519,067 US20190348285A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2019-07-23 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US17/388,403 US20210366709A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2021-07-29 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
Applications Claiming Priority (7)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
JP2009156410 | 2009-06-30 | ||
JP2009-156410 | 2009-06-30 | ||
US12/826,000 US8557641B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2010-06-29 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US14/022,392 US8846460B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2013-09-10 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US14/480,760 US10062570B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2014-09-09 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US16/110,396 US10796908B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2018-08-23 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US16/519,067 US20190348285A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2019-07-23 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US16/110,396 Continuation US10796908B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2018-08-23 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US17/388,403 Continuation US20210366709A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2021-07-29 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20190348285A1 true US20190348285A1 (en) | 2019-11-14 |
Family
ID=43410954
Family Applications (6)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US12/826,000 Active US8557641B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2010-06-29 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US14/022,392 Active US8846460B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2013-09-10 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US14/480,760 Active US10062570B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2014-09-09 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US16/110,396 Active US10796908B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2018-08-23 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US16/519,067 Abandoned US20190348285A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2019-07-23 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US17/388,403 Pending US20210366709A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2021-07-29 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
Family Applications Before (4)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US12/826,000 Active US8557641B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2010-06-29 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US14/022,392 Active US8846460B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2013-09-10 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US14/480,760 Active US10062570B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2014-09-09 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US16/110,396 Active US10796908B2 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2018-08-23 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
Family Applications After (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US17/388,403 Pending US20210366709A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2021-07-29 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
Country Status (7)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (6) | US8557641B2 (en) |
EP (2) | EP2449594B1 (en) |
JP (11) | JP5459909B2 (en) |
KR (8) | KR101644249B1 (en) |
CN (3) | CN111081550A (en) |
TW (6) | TW201943085A (en) |
WO (1) | WO2011001879A1 (en) |
Cited By (1)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US10741414B2 (en) | 2013-10-10 | 2020-08-11 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device |
Families Citing this family (46)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
KR101644249B1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2016-07-29 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
KR101968855B1 (en) * | 2009-06-30 | 2019-04-12 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
WO2011002046A1 (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2011-01-06 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
CN102473728B (en) | 2009-06-30 | 2014-11-26 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
WO2011001822A1 (en) * | 2009-07-03 | 2011-01-06 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
SG10201403913PA (en) | 2009-07-10 | 2014-10-30 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
TWI559501B (en) | 2009-08-07 | 2016-11-21 | 半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method thereof |
WO2011027656A1 (en) | 2009-09-04 | 2011-03-10 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Transistor and display device |
CN104681447A (en) | 2009-09-04 | 2015-06-03 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | Manufacturing Method Of Semiconductor Device |
CN107195328B (en) | 2009-10-09 | 2020-11-10 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | Shift register, display device and driving method thereof |
WO2011062043A1 (en) | 2009-11-20 | 2011-05-26 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
CN105789321B (en) | 2010-03-26 | 2019-08-20 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | The manufacturing method of semiconductor device |
WO2011118741A1 (en) | 2010-03-26 | 2011-09-29 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
WO2011145484A1 (en) | 2010-05-21 | 2011-11-24 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device |
US8906756B2 (en) | 2010-05-21 | 2014-12-09 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
KR20130082091A (en) | 2010-05-21 | 2013-07-18 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method thereof |
US8441010B2 (en) | 2010-07-01 | 2013-05-14 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device |
KR101885691B1 (en) | 2010-07-27 | 2018-08-06 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Semiconductor device and method of manufacturing the same |
JP5189674B2 (en) * | 2010-12-28 | 2013-04-24 | 出光興産株式会社 | Laminated structure having oxide semiconductor thin film layer, method for producing laminated structure, thin film transistor, and display device |
US8957442B2 (en) * | 2011-02-11 | 2015-02-17 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting device and display device |
JP5766467B2 (en) | 2011-03-02 | 2015-08-19 | 株式会社東芝 | THIN FILM TRANSISTOR, MANUFACTURING METHOD THEREOF, AND DISPLAY DEVICE |
JP5657434B2 (en) * | 2011-03-14 | 2015-01-21 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Method for manufacturing oxide semiconductor thin film, field effect transistor, display device, and sensor |
TWI545652B (en) | 2011-03-25 | 2016-08-11 | 半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method thereof |
US9012904B2 (en) * | 2011-03-25 | 2015-04-21 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US9219159B2 (en) | 2011-03-25 | 2015-12-22 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for forming oxide semiconductor film and method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
JP2012256406A (en) * | 2011-04-08 | 2012-12-27 | Semiconductor Energy Lab Co Ltd | Memory device and semiconductor device using the same |
JP2013087962A (en) * | 2011-10-13 | 2013-05-13 | Panasonic Corp | Heating cooker |
TWI642193B (en) * | 2012-01-26 | 2018-11-21 | 半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
WO2015081416A1 (en) * | 2013-12-04 | 2015-06-11 | The Governors Of The University Of Alberta | Buried source schottky barrier thin film transistor and method of manufacture |
US9048265B2 (en) | 2012-05-31 | 2015-06-02 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device comprising oxide semiconductor layer |
WO2014073585A1 (en) | 2012-11-08 | 2014-05-15 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Metal oxide film and method for forming metal oxide film |
KR102712705B1 (en) * | 2012-12-28 | 2024-10-04 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Semiconductor device |
JP6401483B2 (en) | 2013-04-26 | 2018-10-10 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
KR102169628B1 (en) * | 2013-11-26 | 2020-10-23 | 한국전자통신연구원 | Method for forming oxide semiconductor |
CN104810263B (en) * | 2014-01-24 | 2018-11-20 | 北大方正集团有限公司 | The manufacturing method of gate oxide |
US10158027B2 (en) | 2014-06-03 | 2018-12-18 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing same |
US20160163869A1 (en) * | 2014-12-08 | 2016-06-09 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Transistor |
CN104576656A (en) * | 2014-12-23 | 2015-04-29 | 京东方科技集团股份有限公司 | Display substrate and manufacturing method of thereof, and display device |
JP6097808B2 (en) * | 2015-10-15 | 2017-03-15 | 株式会社ジャパンディスプレイ | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method of semiconductor device |
CN107039298B (en) * | 2016-11-04 | 2019-12-24 | 厦门市三安光电科技有限公司 | Transfer device, transfer method, manufacturing method, device and electronic apparatus for micro-component |
KR102343573B1 (en) * | 2017-05-26 | 2021-12-28 | 삼성디스플레이 주식회사 | Flexible display device |
CN107369716B (en) * | 2017-07-17 | 2021-02-12 | 京东方科技集团股份有限公司 | Thin film transistor, manufacturing method and display device |
US11152513B2 (en) | 2017-09-05 | 2021-10-19 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
KR20210009000A (en) | 2019-07-16 | 2021-01-26 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Semiconductor device |
CN111952317B (en) * | 2020-08-04 | 2024-04-09 | 长江存储科技有限责任公司 | Three-dimensional memory and preparation method thereof |
KR102410310B1 (en) * | 2021-05-03 | 2022-06-22 | (주) 엔지온 | Measuring unit of electrical characteristic of semiconductor an apparatus for measuring electrical characteristic of semiconductor and a method for using the same |
Citations (5)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20060108636A1 (en) * | 2004-11-10 | 2006-05-25 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Amorphous oxide and field effect transistor |
US20080239189A1 (en) * | 2007-03-28 | 2008-10-02 | Toppan Printing Co., Ltd. | Thin film transistor array, method for manufacturing the same and active matrix display |
US20080258140A1 (en) * | 2007-04-20 | 2008-10-23 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Thin film transistor including selectively crystallized channel layer and method of manufacturing the thin film transistor |
US20090065771A1 (en) * | 2006-03-17 | 2009-03-12 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Field effect transistor using oxide film for channel and method of manufacturing the same |
US20100105164A1 (en) * | 2008-10-24 | 2010-04-29 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
Family Cites Families (181)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
EP0051940B1 (en) | 1980-11-06 | 1985-05-02 | National Research Development Corporation | Annealing process for a thin-film semiconductor device and obtained devices |
JPS60198861A (en) | 1984-03-23 | 1985-10-08 | Fujitsu Ltd | Thin film transistor |
JPH0244256B2 (en) | 1987-01-28 | 1990-10-03 | Kagaku Gijutsucho Mukizaishitsu Kenkyushocho | INGAZN2O5DESHIMESARERUROTSUHOSHOKEINOSOJOKOZOOJUSURUKAGOBUTSUOYOBISONOSEIZOHO |
JPH0244258B2 (en) | 1987-02-24 | 1990-10-03 | Kagaku Gijutsucho Mukizaishitsu Kenkyushocho | INGAZN3O6DESHIMESARERUROTSUHOSHOKEINOSOJOKOZOOJUSURUKAGOBUTSUOYOBISONOSEIZOHO |
JPS63210023A (en) | 1987-02-24 | 1988-08-31 | Natl Inst For Res In Inorg Mater | Compound having laminar structure of hexagonal crystal system expressed by ingazn4o7 and its production |
JPH0244260B2 (en) | 1987-02-24 | 1990-10-03 | Kagaku Gijutsucho Mukizaishitsu Kenkyushocho | INGAZN5O8DESHIMESARERUROTSUHOSHOKEINOSOJOKOZOOJUSURUKAGOBUTSUOYOBISONOSEIZOHO |
JPH0244262B2 (en) | 1987-02-27 | 1990-10-03 | Kagaku Gijutsucho Mukizaishitsu Kenkyushocho | INGAZN6O9DESHIMESARERUROTSUHOSHOKEINOSOJOKOZOOJUSURUKAGOBUTSUOYOBISONOSEIZOHO |
JPH0244263B2 (en) | 1987-04-22 | 1990-10-03 | Kagaku Gijutsucho Mukizaishitsu Kenkyushocho | INGAZN7O10DESHIMESARERUROTSUHOSHOKEINOSOJOKOZOOJUSURUKAGOBUTSUOYOBISONOSEIZOHO |
JP2652267B2 (en) * | 1990-10-29 | 1997-09-10 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Insulated gate type semiconductor device |
JPH05251705A (en) | 1992-03-04 | 1993-09-28 | Fuji Xerox Co Ltd | Thin-film transistor |
JP3479375B2 (en) | 1995-03-27 | 2003-12-15 | 科学技術振興事業団 | Metal oxide semiconductor device in which a pn junction is formed with a thin film transistor made of a metal oxide semiconductor such as cuprous oxide, and methods for manufacturing the same |
DE69635107D1 (en) | 1995-08-03 | 2005-09-29 | Koninkl Philips Electronics Nv | SEMICONDUCTOR ARRANGEMENT WITH A TRANSPARENT CIRCUIT ELEMENT |
JP3625598B2 (en) | 1995-12-30 | 2005-03-02 | 三星電子株式会社 | Manufacturing method of liquid crystal display device |
JP3394433B2 (en) * | 1997-10-16 | 2003-04-07 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Active matrix liquid crystal display |
JP4170454B2 (en) | 1998-07-24 | 2008-10-22 | Hoya株式会社 | Article having transparent conductive oxide thin film and method for producing the same |
TW449949B (en) | 1998-09-10 | 2001-08-11 | Rohm Co Ltd | Light emitting semiconductor element and method for manufacturing the same |
JP4365530B2 (en) | 1998-09-10 | 2009-11-18 | ローム株式会社 | Semiconductor light emitting device and manufacturing method thereof |
JP2000150861A (en) | 1998-11-16 | 2000-05-30 | Tdk Corp | Oxide thin film |
JP3276930B2 (en) | 1998-11-17 | 2002-04-22 | 科学技術振興事業団 | Transistor and semiconductor device |
US6573195B1 (en) * | 1999-01-26 | 2003-06-03 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing a semiconductor device by performing a heat-treatment in a hydrogen atmosphere |
JP2000357586A (en) | 1999-06-15 | 2000-12-26 | Sharp Corp | Manufacture of thin film el element and thin film el element |
TW460731B (en) | 1999-09-03 | 2001-10-21 | Ind Tech Res Inst | Electrode structure and production method of wide viewing angle LCD |
JP4089858B2 (en) | 2000-09-01 | 2008-05-28 | 国立大学法人東北大学 | Semiconductor device |
KR20020038482A (en) | 2000-11-15 | 2002-05-23 | 모리시타 요이찌 | Thin film transistor array, method for producing the same, and display panel using the same |
JP3997731B2 (en) | 2001-03-19 | 2007-10-24 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | Method for forming a crystalline semiconductor thin film on a substrate |
JP2002289859A (en) | 2001-03-23 | 2002-10-04 | Minolta Co Ltd | Thin-film transistor |
JP2003037268A (en) * | 2001-07-24 | 2003-02-07 | Minolta Co Ltd | Semiconductor element and manufacturing method therefor |
JP4090716B2 (en) | 2001-09-10 | 2008-05-28 | 雅司 川崎 | Thin film transistor and matrix display device |
JP3925839B2 (en) | 2001-09-10 | 2007-06-06 | シャープ株式会社 | Semiconductor memory device and test method thereof |
US7061014B2 (en) | 2001-11-05 | 2006-06-13 | Japan Science And Technology Agency | Natural-superlattice homologous single crystal thin film, method for preparation thereof, and device using said single crystal thin film |
JP4164562B2 (en) | 2002-09-11 | 2008-10-15 | 独立行政法人科学技術振興機構 | Transparent thin film field effect transistor using homologous thin film as active layer |
JP4083486B2 (en) | 2002-02-21 | 2008-04-30 | 独立行政法人科学技術振興機構 | Method for producing LnCuO (S, Se, Te) single crystal thin film |
US7049190B2 (en) | 2002-03-15 | 2006-05-23 | Sanyo Electric Co., Ltd. | Method for forming ZnO film, method for forming ZnO semiconductor layer, method for fabricating semiconductor device, and semiconductor device |
US7119365B2 (en) | 2002-03-26 | 2006-10-10 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method thereof, SOI substrate and display device using the same, and manufacturing method of the SOI substrate |
JP3933591B2 (en) | 2002-03-26 | 2007-06-20 | 淳二 城戸 | Organic electroluminescent device |
US7339187B2 (en) | 2002-05-21 | 2008-03-04 | State Of Oregon Acting By And Through The Oregon State Board Of Higher Education On Behalf Of Oregon State University | Transistor structures |
JP2004022625A (en) | 2002-06-13 | 2004-01-22 | Murata Mfg Co Ltd | Manufacturing method of semiconductor device and its manufacturing method |
US7105868B2 (en) | 2002-06-24 | 2006-09-12 | Cermet, Inc. | High-electron mobility transistor with zinc oxide |
US7067843B2 (en) | 2002-10-11 | 2006-06-27 | E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company | Transparent oxide semiconductor thin film transistors |
JP4166105B2 (en) | 2003-03-06 | 2008-10-15 | シャープ株式会社 | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method thereof |
KR100470155B1 (en) * | 2003-03-07 | 2005-02-04 | 광주과학기술원 | Manufacturing method of zinc oxide semiconductor |
JP2004273732A (en) | 2003-03-07 | 2004-09-30 | Sharp Corp | Active matrix substrate and its producing process |
JP4360826B2 (en) * | 2003-04-24 | 2009-11-11 | シャープ株式会社 | Semiconductor film and manufacturing method thereof |
JP4108633B2 (en) | 2003-06-20 | 2008-06-25 | シャープ株式会社 | THIN FILM TRANSISTOR, MANUFACTURING METHOD THEREOF, AND ELECTRONIC DEVICE |
US7262463B2 (en) | 2003-07-25 | 2007-08-28 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Transistor including a deposited channel region having a doped portion |
CN1998087B (en) | 2004-03-12 | 2014-12-31 | 独立行政法人科学技术振兴机构 | Amorphous oxide and thin film transistor |
US7145174B2 (en) | 2004-03-12 | 2006-12-05 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, Lp. | Semiconductor device |
US7297977B2 (en) | 2004-03-12 | 2007-11-20 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Semiconductor device |
US7282782B2 (en) | 2004-03-12 | 2007-10-16 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Combined binary oxide semiconductor device |
US7211825B2 (en) | 2004-06-14 | 2007-05-01 | Yi-Chi Shih | Indium oxide-based thin film transistors and circuits |
JP2006100760A (en) | 2004-09-02 | 2006-04-13 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Thin-film transistor and its manufacturing method |
US7285501B2 (en) | 2004-09-17 | 2007-10-23 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Method of forming a solution processed device |
US7382421B2 (en) | 2004-10-12 | 2008-06-03 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Thin film transistor with a passivation layer |
US7298084B2 (en) | 2004-11-02 | 2007-11-20 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Methods and displays utilizing integrated zinc oxide row and column drivers in conjunction with organic light emitting diodes |
US7453065B2 (en) | 2004-11-10 | 2008-11-18 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Sensor and image pickup device |
US7791072B2 (en) | 2004-11-10 | 2010-09-07 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Display |
US7829444B2 (en) | 2004-11-10 | 2010-11-09 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Field effect transistor manufacturing method |
US7863611B2 (en) | 2004-11-10 | 2011-01-04 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Integrated circuits utilizing amorphous oxides |
WO2006051995A1 (en) | 2004-11-10 | 2006-05-18 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Field effect transistor employing an amorphous oxide |
EP1810335B1 (en) | 2004-11-10 | 2020-05-27 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Light-emitting device |
KR101142996B1 (en) | 2004-12-31 | 2012-05-08 | 재단법인서울대학교산학협력재단 | Display device and driving method thereof |
JP5094019B2 (en) | 2005-01-21 | 2012-12-12 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
US7579224B2 (en) | 2005-01-21 | 2009-08-25 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing a thin film semiconductor device |
TWI412138B (en) | 2005-01-28 | 2013-10-11 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | Semiconductor device, electronic device, and method of manufacturing semiconductor device |
JP5171003B2 (en) | 2005-01-28 | 2013-03-27 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Semiconductor device |
TWI569441B (en) | 2005-01-28 | 2017-02-01 | 半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | Semiconductor device, electronic device, and method of manufacturing semiconductor device |
US7858451B2 (en) | 2005-02-03 | 2010-12-28 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Electronic device, semiconductor device and manufacturing method thereof |
US7948171B2 (en) | 2005-02-18 | 2011-05-24 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light emitting device |
US20060197092A1 (en) | 2005-03-03 | 2006-09-07 | Randy Hoffman | System and method for forming conductive material on a substrate |
US8681077B2 (en) | 2005-03-18 | 2014-03-25 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device, and display device, driving method and electronic apparatus thereof |
WO2006105077A2 (en) | 2005-03-28 | 2006-10-05 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Low voltage thin film transistor with high-k dielectric material |
US7645478B2 (en) | 2005-03-31 | 2010-01-12 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Methods of making displays |
US8300031B2 (en) | 2005-04-20 | 2012-10-30 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device comprising transistor having gate and drain connected through a current-voltage conversion element |
JP2006344849A (en) | 2005-06-10 | 2006-12-21 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Thin film transistor |
US7691666B2 (en) | 2005-06-16 | 2010-04-06 | Eastman Kodak Company | Methods of making thin film transistors comprising zinc-oxide-based semiconductor materials and transistors made thereby |
US7402506B2 (en) | 2005-06-16 | 2008-07-22 | Eastman Kodak Company | Methods of making thin film transistors comprising zinc-oxide-based semiconductor materials and transistors made thereby |
US7507618B2 (en) | 2005-06-27 | 2009-03-24 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Method for making electronic devices using metal oxide nanoparticles |
KR100711890B1 (en) | 2005-07-28 | 2007-04-25 | 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 | Organic Light Emitting Display and Fabrication Method for the same |
JP2007059128A (en) | 2005-08-23 | 2007-03-08 | Canon Inc | Organic electroluminescent display device and manufacturing method thereof |
JP4873528B2 (en) * | 2005-09-02 | 2012-02-08 | 財団法人高知県産業振興センター | Thin film transistor manufacturing method |
JP4850457B2 (en) | 2005-09-06 | 2012-01-11 | キヤノン株式会社 | Thin film transistor and thin film diode |
JP4560502B2 (en) | 2005-09-06 | 2010-10-13 | キヤノン株式会社 | Field effect transistor |
JP5116225B2 (en) | 2005-09-06 | 2013-01-09 | キヤノン株式会社 | Manufacturing method of oxide semiconductor device |
JP2007073705A (en) | 2005-09-06 | 2007-03-22 | Canon Inc | Oxide-semiconductor channel film transistor and its method of manufacturing same |
JP4280736B2 (en) | 2005-09-06 | 2009-06-17 | キヤノン株式会社 | Semiconductor element |
CN101258607B (en) * | 2005-09-06 | 2011-01-05 | 佳能株式会社 | Field effect transistor using amorphous oxide film as channel layer, manufacturing method of field effect transistor using amorphous oxide film as channel layer, and manufacturing method of amorphous |
JP5064747B2 (en) * | 2005-09-29 | 2012-10-31 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Semiconductor device, electrophoretic display device, display module, electronic device, and method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
EP1995787A3 (en) | 2005-09-29 | 2012-01-18 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co, Ltd. | Semiconductor device having oxide semiconductor layer and manufacturing method therof |
JP5078246B2 (en) | 2005-09-29 | 2012-11-21 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method of semiconductor device |
JP5037808B2 (en) | 2005-10-20 | 2012-10-03 | キヤノン株式会社 | Field effect transistor using amorphous oxide, and display device using the transistor |
US7485928B2 (en) | 2005-11-09 | 2009-02-03 | Memc Electronic Materials, Inc. | Arsenic and phosphorus doped silicon wafer substrates having intrinsic gettering |
KR101112655B1 (en) | 2005-11-15 | 2012-02-16 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Active Matrix Display Device and a Television Receiver Including the Same |
TWI292281B (en) | 2005-12-29 | 2008-01-01 | Ind Tech Res Inst | Pixel structure of active organic light emitting diode and method of fabricating the same |
US7867636B2 (en) | 2006-01-11 | 2011-01-11 | Murata Manufacturing Co., Ltd. | Transparent conductive film and method for manufacturing the same |
JP4977478B2 (en) | 2006-01-21 | 2012-07-18 | 三星電子株式会社 | ZnO film and method of manufacturing TFT using the same |
US7576394B2 (en) | 2006-02-02 | 2009-08-18 | Kochi Industrial Promotion Center | Thin film transistor including low resistance conductive thin films and manufacturing method thereof |
JP5015471B2 (en) | 2006-02-15 | 2012-08-29 | 財団法人高知県産業振興センター | Thin film transistor and manufacturing method thereof |
US7977169B2 (en) | 2006-02-15 | 2011-07-12 | Kochi Industrial Promotion Center | Semiconductor device including active layer made of zinc oxide with controlled orientations and manufacturing method thereof |
JP4930704B2 (en) * | 2006-03-14 | 2012-05-16 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Organic electroluminescence device and electronic device |
US7435633B2 (en) | 2006-03-14 | 2008-10-14 | Seiko Epson Corporation | Electroluminescence device, manufacturing method thereof, and electronic apparatus |
KR20070101595A (en) | 2006-04-11 | 2007-10-17 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Zno thin film transistor |
KR100785038B1 (en) * | 2006-04-17 | 2007-12-12 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Amorphous ZnO based Thin Film Transistor |
US20070252928A1 (en) | 2006-04-28 | 2007-11-01 | Toppan Printing Co., Ltd. | Structure, transmission type liquid crystal display, reflection type display and manufacturing method thereof |
JP2007311404A (en) | 2006-05-16 | 2007-11-29 | Fuji Electric Holdings Co Ltd | Process for fabricating thin film transistor |
JP5028033B2 (en) | 2006-06-13 | 2012-09-19 | キヤノン株式会社 | Oxide semiconductor film dry etching method |
JPWO2007148601A1 (en) * | 2006-06-19 | 2009-11-19 | パナソニック株式会社 | THIN FILM TRANSISTOR, MANUFACTURING METHOD THEREOF, AND ELECTRONIC DEVICE USING THE SAME |
JP4321557B2 (en) | 2006-07-06 | 2009-08-26 | エプソンイメージングデバイス株式会社 | Electro-optical device, method of manufacturing electro-optical device, and electronic apparatus |
US7906415B2 (en) * | 2006-07-28 | 2011-03-15 | Xerox Corporation | Device having zinc oxide semiconductor and indium/zinc electrode |
JP4609797B2 (en) * | 2006-08-09 | 2011-01-12 | Nec液晶テクノロジー株式会社 | Thin film device and manufacturing method thereof |
JP4999400B2 (en) | 2006-08-09 | 2012-08-15 | キヤノン株式会社 | Oxide semiconductor film dry etching method |
JP5127183B2 (en) | 2006-08-23 | 2013-01-23 | キヤノン株式会社 | Thin film transistor manufacturing method using amorphous oxide semiconductor film |
JP4332545B2 (en) | 2006-09-15 | 2009-09-16 | キヤノン株式会社 | Field effect transistor and manufacturing method thereof |
JP5164357B2 (en) | 2006-09-27 | 2013-03-21 | キヤノン株式会社 | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method of semiconductor device |
JP4274219B2 (en) | 2006-09-27 | 2009-06-03 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Electronic devices, organic electroluminescence devices, organic thin film semiconductor devices |
US7622371B2 (en) | 2006-10-10 | 2009-11-24 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Fused nanocrystal thin film semiconductor and method |
JP2008117863A (en) * | 2006-11-01 | 2008-05-22 | Sharp Corp | Semiconductor element, and display device |
US7772021B2 (en) | 2006-11-29 | 2010-08-10 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Flat panel displays comprising a thin-film transistor having a semiconductive oxide in its channel and methods of fabricating the same for use in flat panel displays |
JP2008140684A (en) | 2006-12-04 | 2008-06-19 | Toppan Printing Co Ltd | Color el display, and its manufacturing method |
WO2008069255A1 (en) | 2006-12-05 | 2008-06-12 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Method for manufacturing thin film transistor using oxide semiconductor and display apparatus |
JP5105842B2 (en) | 2006-12-05 | 2012-12-26 | キヤノン株式会社 | Display device using oxide semiconductor and manufacturing method thereof |
US8143115B2 (en) | 2006-12-05 | 2012-03-27 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Method for manufacturing thin film transistor using oxide semiconductor and display apparatus |
JP5305630B2 (en) | 2006-12-05 | 2013-10-02 | キヤノン株式会社 | Manufacturing method of bottom gate type thin film transistor and manufacturing method of display device |
KR101303578B1 (en) | 2007-01-05 | 2013-09-09 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Etching method of thin film |
US8207063B2 (en) | 2007-01-26 | 2012-06-26 | Eastman Kodak Company | Process for atomic layer deposition |
KR100862593B1 (en) | 2007-02-01 | 2008-10-09 | 한양대학교 산학협력단 | Transparent conductive thin film and method of fabricating thereof |
US8436349B2 (en) * | 2007-02-20 | 2013-05-07 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Thin-film transistor fabrication process and display device |
WO2008105347A1 (en) | 2007-02-20 | 2008-09-04 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Thin-film transistor fabrication process and display device |
JP5196870B2 (en) | 2007-05-23 | 2013-05-15 | キヤノン株式会社 | Electronic device using oxide semiconductor and method for manufacturing the same |
KR100851215B1 (en) | 2007-03-14 | 2008-08-07 | 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 | Thin film transistor and organic light-emitting dislplay device having the thin film transistor |
WO2008126879A1 (en) | 2007-04-09 | 2008-10-23 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Light-emitting apparatus and production method thereof |
JP5197058B2 (en) * | 2007-04-09 | 2013-05-15 | キヤノン株式会社 | Light emitting device and manufacturing method thereof |
US7795613B2 (en) | 2007-04-17 | 2010-09-14 | Toppan Printing Co., Ltd. | Structure with transistor |
KR101325053B1 (en) | 2007-04-18 | 2013-11-05 | 삼성디스플레이 주식회사 | Thin film transistor substrate and manufacturing method thereof |
KR20080094300A (en) | 2007-04-19 | 2008-10-23 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Thin film transistor and method of manufacturing the same and flat panel display comprising the same |
CN101663762B (en) | 2007-04-25 | 2011-09-21 | 佳能株式会社 | Oxynitride semiconductor |
KR100982395B1 (en) | 2007-04-25 | 2010-09-14 | 주식회사 엘지화학 | Thin film transistor and method for preparing the same |
JP5215589B2 (en) | 2007-05-11 | 2013-06-19 | キヤノン株式会社 | Insulated gate transistor and display device |
JP2008284136A (en) | 2007-05-17 | 2008-11-27 | Shimadzu Corp | Attachment for ultrasonic probe and ultrasonic probe |
JP5294651B2 (en) * | 2007-05-18 | 2013-09-18 | キヤノン株式会社 | Inverter manufacturing method and inverter |
KR101334182B1 (en) * | 2007-05-28 | 2013-11-28 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Fabrication method of ZnO family Thin film transistor |
KR101345376B1 (en) | 2007-05-29 | 2013-12-24 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Fabrication method of ZnO family Thin film transistor |
KR100873081B1 (en) * | 2007-05-29 | 2008-12-09 | 삼성모바일디스플레이주식회사 | Thin film transistor, method of manufacturing the thin film transistor and flat panel display device having the thin film transistor |
JP5406449B2 (en) * | 2007-05-30 | 2014-02-05 | キヤノン株式会社 | Thin film transistor manufacturing method and display device using oxide semiconductor |
CN101681928B (en) | 2007-05-31 | 2012-08-29 | 佳能株式会社 | Manufacturing method of thin film transistor using oxide semiconductor |
JP5242083B2 (en) * | 2007-06-13 | 2013-07-24 | 出光興産株式会社 | Crystalline oxide semiconductor and thin film transistor using the same |
US7682882B2 (en) * | 2007-06-20 | 2010-03-23 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method of manufacturing ZnO-based thin film transistor |
US20090001881A1 (en) * | 2007-06-28 | 2009-01-01 | Masaya Nakayama | Organic el display and manufacturing method thereof |
JP2009031750A (en) * | 2007-06-28 | 2009-02-12 | Fujifilm Corp | Organic el display device and manufacturing method thereof |
US8354674B2 (en) | 2007-06-29 | 2013-01-15 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device wherein a property of a first semiconductor layer is different from a property of a second semiconductor layer |
US8686412B2 (en) * | 2007-07-31 | 2014-04-01 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Microelectronic device |
KR101536101B1 (en) | 2007-08-02 | 2015-07-13 | 어플라이드 머티어리얼스, 인코포레이티드 | Thin film transistors using thin film semiconductor materials |
KR100882677B1 (en) | 2007-08-20 | 2009-02-06 | 삼성모바일디스플레이주식회사 | Thin film transistor, method of manufacturing the thin film transistor and flat panel display device having the thin film transistor |
KR100907400B1 (en) * | 2007-08-28 | 2009-07-10 | 삼성모바일디스플레이주식회사 | Thin film transistor and Light-emitting dislplay device having the thin film transistor |
JP4759598B2 (en) | 2007-09-28 | 2011-08-31 | キヤノン株式会社 | THIN FILM TRANSISTOR, MANUFACTURING METHOD THEREOF, AND DISPLAY DEVICE USING THE SAME |
JP2009099847A (en) * | 2007-10-18 | 2009-05-07 | Canon Inc | Thin-film transistor, its manufacturing method, and display device |
JP5489445B2 (en) * | 2007-11-15 | 2014-05-14 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Thin film field effect transistor and display device using the same |
KR100947748B1 (en) * | 2007-11-16 | 2010-03-17 | 광주과학기술원 | Method for Manufacturing Zinc Oxide Semiconductors Having P-Type Electrical Property |
JP2009128761A (en) * | 2007-11-27 | 2009-06-11 | Sharp Corp | Substrate device and method for manufacturing the same, and display device |
JP5183173B2 (en) * | 2007-11-29 | 2013-04-17 | 株式会社ジャパンディスプレイウェスト | Optical sensor and display device |
KR101413655B1 (en) * | 2007-11-30 | 2014-08-07 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Fabrication method of oxide semiconductor thin film transistor |
KR101270174B1 (en) | 2007-12-03 | 2013-05-31 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Method of manufacturing oxide semiconductor thin film transistor |
JP5213422B2 (en) | 2007-12-04 | 2013-06-19 | キヤノン株式会社 | Oxide semiconductor element having insulating layer and display device using the same |
US8384077B2 (en) | 2007-12-13 | 2013-02-26 | Idemitsu Kosan Co., Ltd | Field effect transistor using oxide semicondutor and method for manufacturing the same |
US8202365B2 (en) | 2007-12-17 | 2012-06-19 | Fujifilm Corporation | Process for producing oriented inorganic crystalline film, and semiconductor device using the oriented inorganic crystalline film |
JP2009156410A (en) | 2007-12-27 | 2009-07-16 | Toyota Motor Corp | Flow-rate adjusting device and high-pressure gas container |
WO2009139009A1 (en) * | 2008-05-14 | 2009-11-19 | Valigeria Roncato S. P. A. | Luggage article having a handle |
KR100963104B1 (en) | 2008-07-08 | 2010-06-14 | 삼성모바일디스플레이주식회사 | Thin film transistor, method of manufacturing the thin film transistor and flat panel display device having the thin film transistor |
US7812346B2 (en) * | 2008-07-16 | 2010-10-12 | Cbrite, Inc. | Metal oxide TFT with improved carrier mobility |
TWI491048B (en) * | 2008-07-31 | 2015-07-01 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | Semiconductor device |
TWI469354B (en) | 2008-07-31 | 2015-01-11 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
TWI500160B (en) | 2008-08-08 | 2015-09-11 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
US8129718B2 (en) | 2008-08-28 | 2012-03-06 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Amorphous oxide semiconductor and thin film transistor using the same |
US9082857B2 (en) | 2008-09-01 | 2015-07-14 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device comprising an oxide semiconductor layer |
JP4623179B2 (en) | 2008-09-18 | 2011-02-02 | ソニー株式会社 | Thin film transistor and manufacturing method thereof |
JP5451280B2 (en) | 2008-10-09 | 2014-03-26 | キヤノン株式会社 | Wurtzite crystal growth substrate, manufacturing method thereof, and semiconductor device |
KR101472771B1 (en) | 2008-12-01 | 2014-12-15 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method thereof |
WO2010071034A1 (en) | 2008-12-19 | 2010-06-24 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing transistor |
KR101608887B1 (en) * | 2009-04-17 | 2016-04-05 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Inverter, method of manufacturing the same and logic circuit comprising inverter |
EP2256814B1 (en) | 2009-05-29 | 2019-01-16 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co, Ltd. | Oxide semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same |
EP2256795B1 (en) | 2009-05-29 | 2014-11-19 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Manufacturing method for oxide semiconductor device |
KR101644249B1 (en) * | 2009-06-30 | 2016-07-29 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
-
2010
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020147009967A patent/KR101644249B1/en active IP Right Grant
- 2010-06-16 EP EP10794048.8A patent/EP2449594B1/en active Active
- 2010-06-16 EP EP19185984.2A patent/EP3573108A1/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020217021830A patent/KR102458127B1/en active IP Right Grant
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020207007586A patent/KR20200031709A/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020157015963A patent/KR101645146B1/en active IP Right Grant
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020127002298A patent/KR101420025B1/en active IP Right Grant
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020187031288A patent/KR20180120804A/en active Search and Examination
- 2010-06-16 WO PCT/JP2010/060694 patent/WO2011001879A1/en active Application Filing
- 2010-06-16 CN CN201911352160.1A patent/CN111081550A/en active Pending
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020167020354A patent/KR101732859B1/en active IP Right Grant
- 2010-06-16 CN CN201610981924.3A patent/CN106409684B/en active Active
- 2010-06-16 CN CN201080028690.1A patent/CN102460713B/en active Active
- 2010-06-16 KR KR1020177011202A patent/KR101915421B1/en active IP Right Grant
- 2010-06-28 TW TW108127768A patent/TW201943085A/en unknown
- 2010-06-28 TW TW104135834A patent/TWI582855B/en active
- 2010-06-28 TW TW106104917A patent/TWI623046B/en active
- 2010-06-28 TW TW108112528A patent/TWI699001B/en active
- 2010-06-28 TW TW107105353A patent/TWI664737B/en active
- 2010-06-28 TW TW099121074A patent/TWI517257B/en active
- 2010-06-29 JP JP2010148185A patent/JP5459909B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2010-06-29 US US12/826,000 patent/US8557641B2/en active Active
-
2013
- 2013-01-25 JP JP2013011965A patent/JP5377779B2/en active Active
- 2013-09-10 US US14/022,392 patent/US8846460B2/en active Active
- 2013-09-24 JP JP2013196494A patent/JP5622909B2/en active Active
-
2014
- 2014-09-09 US US14/480,760 patent/US10062570B2/en active Active
- 2014-09-18 JP JP2014189902A patent/JP5898741B2/en active Active
-
2016
- 2016-03-02 JP JP2016039616A patent/JP6087456B2/en active Active
-
2017
- 2017-02-01 JP JP2017016924A patent/JP2017076823A/en not_active Withdrawn
-
2018
- 2018-07-06 JP JP2018128687A patent/JP2018166216A/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2018-08-23 US US16/110,396 patent/US10796908B2/en active Active
-
2019
- 2019-07-10 JP JP2019128380A patent/JP2019195095A/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2019-07-23 US US16/519,067 patent/US20190348285A1/en not_active Abandoned
-
2020
- 2020-04-01 JP JP2020065757A patent/JP2020115565A/en not_active Withdrawn
-
2021
- 2021-07-29 US US17/388,403 patent/US20210366709A1/en active Pending
-
2022
- 2022-01-19 JP JP2022006195A patent/JP7329632B2/en active Active
-
2023
- 2023-08-07 JP JP2023128508A patent/JP2023155269A/en active Pending
Patent Citations (5)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20060108636A1 (en) * | 2004-11-10 | 2006-05-25 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Amorphous oxide and field effect transistor |
US20090065771A1 (en) * | 2006-03-17 | 2009-03-12 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Field effect transistor using oxide film for channel and method of manufacturing the same |
US20080239189A1 (en) * | 2007-03-28 | 2008-10-02 | Toppan Printing Co., Ltd. | Thin film transistor array, method for manufacturing the same and active matrix display |
US20080258140A1 (en) * | 2007-04-20 | 2008-10-23 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Thin film transistor including selectively crystallized channel layer and method of manufacturing the thin film transistor |
US20100105164A1 (en) * | 2008-10-24 | 2010-04-29 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device |
Cited By (3)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US10741414B2 (en) | 2013-10-10 | 2020-08-11 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device |
US10770310B2 (en) | 2013-10-10 | 2020-09-08 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device |
US11764074B2 (en) | 2013-10-10 | 2023-09-19 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device |
Also Published As
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US20210366709A1 (en) | Semiconductor device and method for manufacturing the same | |
US20230387276A1 (en) | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device | |
US11855194B2 (en) | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device | |
US10090171B2 (en) | Method for manufacturing semiconductor device | |
US8518740B2 (en) | Manufacturing method of semiconductor device | |
US20160307925A1 (en) | Semiconductor device and manufacturing method the same |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: FINAL REJECTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE AFTER FINAL ACTION FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: ADVISORY ACTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: FINAL REJECTION MAILED |
|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION |